3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
6 @include org-version.inc
8 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
9 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
10 @set txicodequoteundirected
11 @set txicodequotebacktick
13 @c Version and Contact Info
14 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
15 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
17 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
18 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
23 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
25 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
26 @c =======================================
28 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
29 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
33 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
35 @c orgkey{key} A key item
36 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
37 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
38 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
39 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
40 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
41 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
42 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
43 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
44 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
47 @c a key but no command
59 @c one key with a command
60 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
61 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
66 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
69 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
78 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
79 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
80 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
85 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
88 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
97 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
98 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
99 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
103 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
106 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
114 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
115 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
116 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
121 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
124 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
133 @c two keys with one command
134 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
135 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
141 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
144 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
150 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
154 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
156 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
157 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
158 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
165 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
169 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
180 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
181 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
182 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
188 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
191 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
197 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
201 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
202 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
203 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
209 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
212 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
218 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
222 @c two keys with two commands
223 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
224 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
225 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
232 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
233 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
236 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
237 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
247 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
250 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
253 @c Subheadings inside a table.
254 @macro tsubheading{text}
256 @subsubheading \text\
264 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
266 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
269 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
270 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
271 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
272 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
273 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
274 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
276 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
277 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
278 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
280 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
281 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
282 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
283 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
287 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
289 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
293 @title The Org Manual
295 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
296 @author by Carsten Dominik
297 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
299 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
301 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
305 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
309 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
316 * Introduction:: Getting started
317 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
318 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
319 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
320 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
321 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
322 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
323 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
324 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
325 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
326 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
327 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
328 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
329 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
330 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
331 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
332 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
333 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
334 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
335 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
336 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
337 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
340 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
344 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
345 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
346 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
347 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
348 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
352 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
353 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
354 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
355 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
356 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
357 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
358 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
359 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
360 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
361 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
362 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
366 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
367 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
368 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
369 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
370 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
371 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
375 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
376 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
377 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
378 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
379 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
380 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
381 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
382 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
383 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
387 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
388 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
389 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
390 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
391 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
392 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
393 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
394 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
398 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
402 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
403 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
404 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
405 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
406 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
407 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
409 Extended use of TODO keywords
411 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
412 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
413 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
414 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
415 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
416 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
417 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
421 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
422 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
423 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
427 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
428 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
429 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
431 Properties and columns
433 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
434 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
435 * Property searches:: Matching property values
436 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
437 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
438 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
442 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
443 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
444 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
448 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
449 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
453 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
454 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
455 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
456 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
457 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
458 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
459 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
463 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
464 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
466 Deadlines and scheduling
468 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
469 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
473 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
474 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
475 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
477 Capture - Refile - Archive
479 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
480 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
481 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
482 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
483 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
484 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
488 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
489 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
490 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
494 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
495 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
496 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
500 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
501 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
505 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
506 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
507 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
508 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
509 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
510 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
511 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
512 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
514 The built-in agenda views
516 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
517 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
518 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
519 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
520 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
521 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
523 Presentation and sorting
525 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
526 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
527 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
531 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
532 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
533 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
535 Markup for rich export
537 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
538 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
539 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
540 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
541 * Index entries:: Making an index
542 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
543 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
545 Structural markup elements
547 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
548 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
549 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
550 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
552 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
553 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
554 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
555 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
556 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
560 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
561 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
562 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
563 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
564 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
568 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
569 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
570 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
571 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
572 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
573 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
574 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
575 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
576 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
577 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
578 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
579 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
583 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
584 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
585 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
586 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
587 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
588 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
589 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
590 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
591 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
592 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
594 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
596 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
597 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
598 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
599 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
600 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
601 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
605 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
606 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
607 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
608 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
609 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
610 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
612 OpenDocument Text export
614 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
615 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
616 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
617 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
618 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
619 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
620 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
621 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
622 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
623 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
624 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
626 Math formatting in ODT export
628 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
629 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
631 Advanced topics in ODT export
633 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
634 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
635 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
636 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
637 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
641 * Configuration:: Defining projects
642 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
643 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
644 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
648 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
649 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
650 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
651 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
652 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
653 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
654 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
655 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
659 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
660 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
662 Working with source code
664 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
665 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
666 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
667 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
668 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
669 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
670 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
671 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
672 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
673 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
674 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
675 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
679 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
680 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
682 Using header arguments
684 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
685 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
686 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
687 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
688 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
689 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
691 Specific header arguments
693 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
694 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
695 be collected and handled
696 * file:: Specify a path for file output
697 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
698 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
699 directory for code block execution
700 * exports:: Export code and/or results
701 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
702 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
703 files during tangling
704 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
706 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
708 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
709 expansion during tangling
710 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
711 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
712 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
713 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
714 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
715 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
716 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
717 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
718 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
719 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
720 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
721 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
725 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
726 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
727 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
728 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
729 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
730 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
731 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
732 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
733 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
734 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
735 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
737 Interaction with other packages
739 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
740 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
744 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
745 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
746 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
747 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
748 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
749 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
750 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
751 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
752 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
753 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
755 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
757 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
758 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
759 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
760 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
764 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
765 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
766 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
771 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
772 @chapter Introduction
776 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
777 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
778 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
779 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
780 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
783 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
787 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
788 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
790 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
791 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
792 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
793 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
794 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
795 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
796 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
797 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
798 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
799 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
800 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
801 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
802 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
805 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
806 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
807 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
809 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
810 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
811 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
813 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
814 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
815 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
816 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
817 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
818 the minor Orgstruct mode.
820 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
821 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
822 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
823 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
827 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
828 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
829 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
830 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
831 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
832 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
833 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
834 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
835 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
840 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
841 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
842 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
843 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
845 @cindex print edition
846 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
847 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
853 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
854 @section Installation
858 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
859 distribution, GNU ELPA installed by the package manager or an XEmacs package,
860 please skip this section and go directly to @ref{Activation}. To see what
861 version of Org (if any) is part of your Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x
862 org-version} (if your Emacs distribution does not come with Org, this
863 function will not be defined).}
865 Installation of Org mode uses a build system, which is described in more
866 detail on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html, Worg}.
868 If you have downloaded Org from the Web as a distribution @file{.zip} or
869 @file{.tar.gz} archive, you must take the following steps to install it:
872 @item Unpack the distribution archive.
873 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org directory.
874 @item Run @code{make help config}
875 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk} if the default configuration
876 does not match your system. You must set the name of the Emacs binary
877 (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
878 directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the Emacs
879 binary is not in your path, you must give the full path to the executable.
880 Avoid spaces in any path names.
881 @item Run @code{make config}
882 again to check the configuration.
883 @item Optionally run @code{make test}
884 to build Org mode and then run the full testsuite.
885 @item Run @code{make install} or @code{sudo make install}
886 to build and install Org mode on your system.
889 If you use a cloned Git repository, then the procedure is slightly different.
890 The following description assumes that you are using the @code{master} branch
891 (where the development is done). You could also use the @code{maint} branch
892 instead, where the release versions are published, just replace @code{master}
893 with @code{maint} in the description below.
896 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
897 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
898 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
899 @item Run @code{make help}
900 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk}. You must set the name of
901 the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths
902 to the directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the
903 Emacs binary is not in your path, you must give the full path to the
904 executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
905 @item Run @code{make config}
906 to check the configuration.
907 @item Run @code{make update2} or @code{make up2}
908 to update the Git repository and build and install Org mode. The latter
909 invocation runs the complete test suite before installation and installs only
910 if the build passes all tests.
913 If you don't have access to the system-wide directories and you don't want to
914 install somewhere into your home directory, you can run Org directly from the
915 distribution directory or Org repository by compiling Org mode in place:
918 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
919 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
920 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
921 @item Run @code{make compile}
924 Last but not least you can also run Org mode directly from an Org repository
925 without any compilation. Simply replace the last step in the recipe above
926 with @code{make uncompiled}.
928 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
931 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
935 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory without
936 compiling them, do a similar step for this directory:
939 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp")
942 If you want to include those files with the build and install, please
943 customize the variable @code{ORG_ADD_CONTRIB} instead in your @code{local.mk}
944 file, for more details please see this
945 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html#sec-4-1-2,
946 description on Worg}.
948 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
949 @file{install-info} program. The Info documentation is installed together
950 with the rest of Org mode. If you don't install Org mode, it is possible to
951 install the Info documentation seperately (you need to have
952 install-info@footnote{The output from install-info (if any) is system
953 dependent. In particular Debian and its derivatives use two different
954 versions of install-info and you may see the message:
957 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
958 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
961 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}
968 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
969 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
970 when Org mode starts.
972 (require 'org-install)
975 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
978 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
982 @cindex global key bindings
983 @cindex key bindings, global
986 @findex org-store-link
989 To make sure files with extension @file{.org} use Org mode, add the following
990 line to your @file{.emacs} file.
992 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
994 @noindent Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the
995 default in Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in
996 Org buffer with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
998 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
999 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
1000 global keys (i.e.@: anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
1001 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
1004 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
1005 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
1006 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
1007 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
1010 @cindex Org mode, turning on
1011 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
1012 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
1016 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
1019 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
1020 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
1021 the file's name is. See also the variable
1022 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
1024 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
1025 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
1026 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
1027 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
1029 (transient-mark-mode 1)
1031 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
1032 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
1033 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
1035 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
1042 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
1043 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
1044 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1045 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1046 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1047 moderators have to do.}.
1049 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1050 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1051 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1052 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1053 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1054 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1055 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1057 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1059 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1060 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1061 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1063 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1064 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1065 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1066 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1067 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1070 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1073 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1074 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as @code{emacs
1075 -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as shown below.
1078 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1080 ;; activate debugging
1081 (setq debug-on-error t
1085 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1086 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1087 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp"))
1090 (require 'org-install)
1093 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1094 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1098 @item What exactly did you do?
1099 @item What did you expect to happen?
1100 @item What happened instead?
1102 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1104 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1106 @cindex backtrace of an error
1107 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1108 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1109 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1110 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1111 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1115 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1116 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1119 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1122 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1125 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1126 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1128 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1129 document the steps you take.
1131 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1132 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1133 attach it to your bug report.
1136 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1137 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1139 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1141 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1142 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1147 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1151 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1152 meaning are written with all capitals.
1155 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1156 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1159 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1160 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1161 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1162 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1163 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1166 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1172 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1173 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1174 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1176 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1177 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1178 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1179 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1180 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1181 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1182 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1183 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1184 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1185 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1187 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1188 @chapter Document structure
1189 @cindex document structure
1190 @cindex structure of document
1192 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1193 edit the structure of the document.
1196 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1197 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1198 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1199 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1200 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1201 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1202 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1203 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1204 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1205 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1206 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1209 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1212 @cindex Outline mode
1214 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1215 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1216 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1217 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1218 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1219 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1220 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1221 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1223 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1226 @cindex outline tree
1227 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1228 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1229 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1231 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1232 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1233 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1234 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1235 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1236 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1239 * Top level headline
1246 * Another top level headline
1249 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1250 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1251 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1253 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1254 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1255 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1256 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1257 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1258 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1260 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1261 @section Visibility cycling
1262 @cindex cycling, visibility
1263 @cindex visibility cycling
1264 @cindex trees, visibility
1265 @cindex show hidden text
1268 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1269 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1270 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1272 @cindex subtree visibility states
1273 @cindex subtree cycling
1274 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1275 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1276 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1278 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1279 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1282 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1283 '-----------------------------------'
1286 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1287 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1288 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1289 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1290 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1291 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1292 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1293 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1295 @cindex global visibility states
1296 @cindex global cycling
1297 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1298 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1299 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1300 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1301 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1302 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1305 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1306 '--------------------------------------'
1309 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1310 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1311 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1313 @cindex show all, command
1314 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1315 Show all, including drawers.
1316 @cindex revealing context
1317 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1318 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1319 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1320 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1321 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1322 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1323 entire subtree of the parent.
1324 @cindex show branches, command
1325 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1326 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1327 @cindex show children, command
1328 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1329 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1330 expose all children down to level N.
1331 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1332 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1335 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1338 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1340 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1341 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1342 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1343 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1344 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1345 the previously used indirect buffer.
1346 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1347 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1350 @vindex org-startup-folded
1351 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1352 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1353 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1354 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1356 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1357 OVERVIEW, i.e.@: only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1358 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1359 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1366 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1369 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1371 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1372 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1373 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1376 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1377 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.@: whatever is
1378 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1382 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1384 @cindex motion, between headlines
1385 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1386 @cindex headline navigation
1387 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1390 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1392 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1394 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1395 Next heading same level.
1396 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1397 Previous heading same level.
1398 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1399 Backward to higher level heading.
1400 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1401 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1402 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1403 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1404 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1406 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1407 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1408 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1409 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1410 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1411 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1412 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1414 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1417 @vindex org-goto-interface
1419 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1422 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1423 @section Structure editing
1424 @cindex structure editing
1425 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1426 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1427 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1428 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1429 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1430 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1431 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1432 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1433 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1436 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1437 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1438 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1439 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1440 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1441 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1442 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1443 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1444 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1445 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1446 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.@:
1447 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1448 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1449 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1450 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1451 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1452 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1453 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1454 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1455 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1456 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1457 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1458 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1459 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1461 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1462 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1463 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1464 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1465 to the initial level.
1466 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1467 Promote current heading by one level.
1468 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1469 Demote current heading by one level.
1470 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1471 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1472 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1473 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1474 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1475 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1477 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1478 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1479 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1480 Kill subtree, i.e.@: remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1481 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1482 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1483 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1484 sequential subtrees.
1485 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1486 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1487 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1488 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1489 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1490 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1491 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1492 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1493 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1494 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1495 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1496 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1497 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1498 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1499 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1500 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1501 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1503 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1504 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1505 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1506 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1507 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1508 more details, see the docstring of the command
1509 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1510 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1511 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1512 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1513 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1514 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1515 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1516 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1517 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1518 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1519 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1520 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1521 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1522 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1523 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1524 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1525 Narrow buffer to current block.
1526 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1527 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1528 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1529 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1530 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1531 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1532 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1533 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1534 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1537 @cindex region, active
1538 @cindex active region
1539 @cindex transient mark mode
1540 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1541 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1542 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1543 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1544 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1545 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1549 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1550 @section Sparse trees
1551 @cindex sparse trees
1552 @cindex trees, sparse
1553 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1554 @cindex occur, command
1556 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1557 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1558 @vindex org-show-siblings
1559 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1560 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1561 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1562 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1563 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1564 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1565 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1566 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1567 and you will see immediately how it works.
1569 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1570 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1573 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1574 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1575 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1576 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1577 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1578 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1579 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1580 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1581 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1582 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1583 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1584 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1585 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1586 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1587 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1588 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1589 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1590 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1595 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1596 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1597 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1598 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1599 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1603 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1604 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1607 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1608 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1610 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1611 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1614 @cindex printing sparse trees
1615 @cindex visible text, printing
1616 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1617 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1618 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1619 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1620 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1621 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1623 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1624 @section Plain lists
1626 @cindex lists, plain
1627 @cindex lists, ordered
1628 @cindex ordered lists
1630 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1631 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1632 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1633 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1635 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1638 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1639 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1640 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1641 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1642 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1643 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1646 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1647 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1648 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1649 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1650 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1651 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1652 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1653 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1654 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1655 list to start with a different value (e.g.@: 20), start the text of the item
1656 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1657 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1658 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1659 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1661 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1662 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1666 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1667 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1668 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1669 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1670 than its bullet/number.
1672 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1673 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1674 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1675 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1676 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1680 ** Lord of the Rings
1681 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1682 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1683 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1684 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1685 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1686 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1688 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1689 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1690 Important actors in this film are:
1691 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1692 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1693 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1697 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1698 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1699 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1700 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1701 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1702 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1703 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1705 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1706 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1707 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1708 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1709 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1710 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1711 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1713 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1714 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1715 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1716 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1717 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1718 to disable them individually.
1721 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1722 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1723 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1724 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1725 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1726 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1727 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1728 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1729 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1730 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1731 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1732 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1733 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1734 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1735 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1736 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1737 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1738 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1739 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1740 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1741 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1742 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1747 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1749 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1750 @kindex S-@key{down}
1753 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1754 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1755 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1756 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1757 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1758 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1759 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1760 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1763 @kindex M-@key{down}
1766 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1767 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1768 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1770 @kindex M-@key{left}
1771 @kindex M-@key{right}
1774 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1775 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1776 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1779 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1780 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1781 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1782 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1783 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1786 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1787 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1788 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1789 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1792 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1793 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1794 consistency in the whole list.
1796 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1798 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1799 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1800 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1801 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1802 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1803 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1804 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1805 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1806 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1809 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1810 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1813 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1814 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1816 @kindex S-@key{left}
1817 @kindex S-@key{right}
1819 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1820 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1821 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1822 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1825 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1826 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1829 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1833 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1836 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1838 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1839 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1840 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1841 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1842 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1846 ** This is a headline
1847 Still outside the drawer
1849 This is inside the drawer.
1854 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1855 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1856 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1857 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1858 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1859 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1861 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1862 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1863 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1864 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1865 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1866 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1867 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1868 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1873 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1876 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1879 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1880 @cindex blocks, folding
1881 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1882 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1883 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1884 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1885 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1886 or on a per-file basis by using
1888 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1889 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1891 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1892 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1895 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1899 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1900 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1901 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1902 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e.@: a footnote is
1903 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1904 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1905 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1906 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1909 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1911 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1914 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1915 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1916 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1917 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1918 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1922 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1923 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1926 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1927 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1928 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1929 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1931 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1932 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1933 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1934 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1937 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1938 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1939 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1940 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1943 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1948 The footnote action command.
1950 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1951 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1953 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1954 @vindex org-footnote-section
1955 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1956 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1957 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1958 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1959 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1960 separately into the location determined by the variable
1961 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1963 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1966 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1967 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1968 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1969 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1970 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1971 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1972 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1973 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1974 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1975 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1976 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1977 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1978 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1979 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g.@: sending}
1980 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1981 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1982 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1985 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1986 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1987 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1992 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1993 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1994 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1998 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1999 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
2000 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
2003 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
2004 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
2005 @cindex Orgstruct mode
2006 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
2008 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
2009 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
2010 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
2011 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
2012 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
2015 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
2016 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
2019 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
2020 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
2021 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
2022 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
2023 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
2024 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
2025 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
2028 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2031 @cindex editing tables
2033 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2034 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2035 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2038 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2039 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2040 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2041 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2042 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2043 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2046 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2047 @section The built-in table editor
2048 @cindex table editor, built-in
2050 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with @samp{|} as
2051 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2052 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2053 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2054 might look like this:
2057 | Name | Phone | Age |
2058 |-------+-------+-----|
2059 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2060 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2063 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2064 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2065 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2066 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2067 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2068 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2069 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2070 create the above table, you would only type
2077 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2078 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2079 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2081 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2082 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2083 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2084 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2085 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2086 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2087 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2088 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2089 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2090 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2093 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2094 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2095 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2096 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2097 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2098 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2099 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2100 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2101 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2103 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2104 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2105 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2107 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2108 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2109 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2111 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2112 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2115 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2116 Re-align, move to previous field.
2118 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2119 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2120 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2121 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2123 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2124 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2125 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2126 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2128 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2129 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2130 Move the current column left/right.
2132 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2133 Kill the current column.
2135 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2136 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2138 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2139 Move the current row up/down.
2141 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2142 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2144 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2145 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2146 created below the current one.
2148 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2149 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2150 is created above the current line.
2152 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2153 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2156 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2157 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2158 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2159 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2160 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2161 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2162 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2163 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2164 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2165 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2167 @tsubheading{Regions}
2168 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2169 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2170 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2171 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2173 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2174 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2175 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2177 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2178 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2179 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2180 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2181 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2184 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2185 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2186 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2187 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2188 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2189 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2190 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2193 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2194 @cindex formula, in tables
2195 @cindex calculations, in tables
2196 @cindex region, active
2197 @cindex active region
2198 @cindex transient mark mode
2199 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2200 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2201 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2202 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2204 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2205 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2206 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2207 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2208 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2209 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2210 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2211 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2212 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2214 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2215 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2216 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2217 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2218 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2219 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2220 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2221 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2222 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2224 @item M-x org-table-import
2225 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2226 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2227 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2228 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2229 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2230 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2232 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2233 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2234 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2235 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2237 @item M-x org-table-export
2238 @findex org-table-export
2239 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2240 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2241 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2242 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2243 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2244 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2245 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2246 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2247 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2248 detailed description.
2251 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2252 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2256 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2259 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2260 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2262 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2263 @section Column width and alignment
2264 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2265 @cindex alignment in tables
2267 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2268 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2269 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2271 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2272 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2273 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2274 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2275 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2276 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2277 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2281 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2283 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2284 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2285 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2286 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2287 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2292 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2293 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2294 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2295 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2296 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2297 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2300 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2301 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2302 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2303 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2304 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2305 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2306 on a per-file basis with:
2313 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2314 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2315 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2316 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2317 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2319 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2320 automatically when exporting the document.
2322 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2323 @section Column groups
2324 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2326 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2327 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2328 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2329 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2330 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2331 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2332 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2333 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2334 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2335 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2336 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2339 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2340 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2341 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2342 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2343 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2344 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2345 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2346 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2349 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2350 every vertical line you would like to have:
2353 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2354 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2358 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2359 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2361 @cindex minor mode for tables
2363 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2364 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2365 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2366 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2367 example in Message mode, use
2370 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2373 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2374 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2375 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2376 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2377 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2379 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2380 @section The spreadsheet
2381 @cindex calculations, in tables
2382 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2383 @cindex @file{calc} package
2385 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2386 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2387 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2388 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2389 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2390 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2391 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2392 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2393 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2396 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2397 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2398 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2399 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2400 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2401 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2402 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2403 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2404 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2407 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2408 @subsection References
2411 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2412 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2413 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2414 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2415 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2417 @subsubheading Field references
2418 @cindex field references
2419 @cindex references, to fields
2421 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2422 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2423 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2424 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2425 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2426 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2427 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2428 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2429 representation that looks like this:
2431 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2434 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2435 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e.@: the
2436 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2437 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2438 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2439 column from the right.
2441 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2442 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2443 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2444 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2445 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2446 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2447 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2448 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2449 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2450 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2451 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc@. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2452 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2453 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2454 after the third hline in the table.
2456 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2457 i.e. to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2458 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2461 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2462 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2463 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2464 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2465 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2466 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2468 Here are a few examples:
2471 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2472 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2473 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2474 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2475 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2476 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2479 @subsubheading Range references
2480 @cindex range references
2481 @cindex references, to ranges
2483 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2484 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2485 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2486 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2487 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2488 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2491 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2492 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2493 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2494 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2495 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2496 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2499 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2500 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2501 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2502 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2503 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2505 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2506 @cindex field coordinates
2507 @cindex coordinates, of field
2508 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2509 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2511 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2512 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2513 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2514 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2517 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2518 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2519 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2522 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2523 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2524 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2527 @subsubheading Named references
2528 @cindex named references
2529 @cindex references, named
2530 @cindex name, of column or field
2531 @cindex constants, in calculations
2534 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2535 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2536 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2537 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2541 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2545 @vindex constants-unit-system
2546 @pindex constants.el
2547 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2548 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2549 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2550 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2551 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2552 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2553 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2554 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2555 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2556 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2557 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2558 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2559 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2560 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2563 @subsubheading Remote references
2564 @cindex remote references
2565 @cindex references, remote
2566 @cindex references, to a different table
2567 @cindex name, of column or field
2568 @cindex constants, in calculations
2571 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2572 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2575 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2579 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2580 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2581 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2582 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2583 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2586 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2587 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2588 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2589 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2591 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2592 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2593 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2594 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2595 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2596 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2597 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2598 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2599 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2600 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2601 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2603 @cindex format specifier
2604 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2605 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2606 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2607 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2608 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2609 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2610 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2611 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2612 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2615 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2616 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2617 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2618 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2619 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2620 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2621 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2622 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2623 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2628 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2629 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2630 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2631 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2632 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2633 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2634 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2635 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2636 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2640 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2641 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2642 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2643 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2644 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2645 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2646 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2647 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2648 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2649 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2650 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2653 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2656 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2659 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2660 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2662 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2663 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2664 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2666 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2667 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2670 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2671 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2672 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2673 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2675 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2676 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2677 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2678 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2679 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2680 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2681 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2682 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2683 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2684 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2686 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2687 computations in Lisp:
2690 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2691 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2692 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2694 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2695 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2698 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2699 @subsection Durations and time values
2700 @cindex Duration, computing
2701 @cindex Time, computing
2702 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2704 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2705 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2709 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2710 |---------+----------+----------|
2711 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2712 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2713 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2717 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2718 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2719 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2720 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2721 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2722 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2725 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2726 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2728 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2729 @subsection Field and range formulas
2730 @cindex field formula
2731 @cindex range formula
2732 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2733 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2735 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2736 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2737 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2738 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2739 current field will be replaced with the result.
2742 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2743 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2744 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2745 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2746 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2747 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2748 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2749 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2750 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2751 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2752 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2754 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2758 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2759 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2760 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2761 it to the current field, and stores it.
2764 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2765 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2766 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2767 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2772 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2773 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2775 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2778 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2779 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2781 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2784 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2785 @subsection Column formulas
2786 @cindex column formula
2787 @cindex formula, for table column
2789 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2790 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2791 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2792 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2793 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2794 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2795 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2797 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2798 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2799 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2800 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2801 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2802 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2803 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2804 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2805 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2806 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2808 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2812 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2813 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2814 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2815 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2816 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g.@: @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2817 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2820 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2821 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2822 @cindex formula editing
2823 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2825 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2826 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2827 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2828 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2829 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2830 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2831 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2832 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2835 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2836 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2837 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2838 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2839 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2840 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2841 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2842 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2843 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2844 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2845 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2847 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2849 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2850 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2851 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2853 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2855 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2856 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2857 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2858 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2859 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2860 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2861 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2862 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2863 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2865 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2866 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2867 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2868 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2869 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2870 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2871 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2872 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2873 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2874 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2875 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2876 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2877 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2878 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2879 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2881 @kindex S-@key{down}
2882 @kindex S-@key{left}
2883 @kindex S-@key{right}
2884 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2885 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2886 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2887 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2888 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2889 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2890 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2891 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2892 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2893 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2895 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2896 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2898 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2900 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2904 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2905 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2906 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2907 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2908 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2911 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2912 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2913 recalculation commands in the table.
2915 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2916 @cindex formula debugging
2917 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2918 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2919 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2920 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2921 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2922 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2923 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2925 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2926 @subsection Updating the table
2927 @cindex recomputing table fields
2928 @cindex updating, table
2930 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2931 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2932 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2934 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2938 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2939 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2940 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2946 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2947 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2949 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2950 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2951 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2952 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2953 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2954 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2955 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2956 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2957 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2958 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2962 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2963 @subsection Advanced features
2965 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2966 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2967 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2968 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2969 special marking characters.
2972 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2973 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2974 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2975 change all marks in the region.
2978 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2979 makes use of these features:
2983 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2984 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2985 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2986 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2987 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2988 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2989 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2990 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2991 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2992 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2993 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
2994 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2995 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2996 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2997 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
3001 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
3002 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
3003 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
3004 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
3007 @cindex marking characters, tables
3008 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3011 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3012 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3014 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3015 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3016 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3017 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3019 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3022 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3023 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3024 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3025 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3028 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3029 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3030 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3031 lines will be left alone by this command.
3033 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3034 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3035 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3037 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3038 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3041 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3042 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3045 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3046 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3047 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3052 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3053 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3054 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3055 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3056 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3057 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3058 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3059 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3060 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3061 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3062 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3066 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3068 @cindex graph, in tables
3069 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3072 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3073 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3074 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
3075 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
3076 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3080 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3081 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3082 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3083 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3084 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3085 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3086 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3087 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3091 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3092 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3093 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3094 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3095 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3096 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3098 @subsubheading Plot Options
3102 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3105 Specify the title of the plot.
3108 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3111 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3112 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3113 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3117 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3120 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3121 (e.g.@: @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3122 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3125 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3128 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3132 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3135 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3136 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3139 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3140 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3143 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3144 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3145 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3146 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3147 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3151 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3155 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3156 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3159 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3160 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3161 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3162 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3163 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3164 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3165 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3166 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3169 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3170 @section Link format
3172 @cindex format, of links
3174 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3175 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3178 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3182 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3183 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3184 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3185 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3186 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3187 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3188 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3189 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3192 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3193 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3194 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3195 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3196 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3197 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3198 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3200 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3201 @section Internal links
3202 @cindex internal links
3203 @cindex links, internal
3204 @cindex targets, for links
3206 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3207 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3208 current file. The most important case is a link like
3209 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3210 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3211 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3212 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3215 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3216 lead to a text search in the current file.
3218 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3219 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3220 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3221 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3222 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3223 comment line. For example
3229 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3230 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3231 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3232 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3235 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3236 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3237 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3238 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3239 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3240 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3241 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3243 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3244 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3245 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3249 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3252 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3253 @subsection Radio targets
3254 @cindex radio targets
3255 @cindex targets, radio
3256 @cindex links, radio targets
3258 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3259 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3260 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3261 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3262 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3263 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3264 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3265 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3266 cursor on or at a target.
3268 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3269 @section External links
3270 @cindex links, external
3271 @cindex external links
3272 @cindex links, external
3280 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3282 @cindex USENET links
3287 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3288 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3289 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3290 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3291 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3294 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3295 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3296 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3297 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3298 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3299 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3300 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3301 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3302 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3303 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3304 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3305 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3306 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3307 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3308 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3309 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3310 will be queried to create it.}
3311 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3312 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3313 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3314 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3315 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3316 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3317 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3318 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3319 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3320 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3321 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3322 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3323 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3324 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3325 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3326 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3327 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3328 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3329 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3330 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3331 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3332 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3333 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3334 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3335 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3336 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3339 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3341 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3342 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3343 format}), for example:
3346 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3350 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3351 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3352 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3354 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3356 @cindex square brackets, around links
3357 @cindex plain text external links
3358 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3359 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3360 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3361 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3363 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3364 @section Handling links
3365 @cindex links, handling
3367 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3368 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3371 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3372 @cindex storing links
3373 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3374 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3375 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3376 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3379 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3380 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3381 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3382 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3383 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3384 timestamp in the headline.}.
3386 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3387 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3388 @cindex property, ID
3389 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3390 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3391 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3392 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3393 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3394 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3395 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3398 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3399 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3400 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3401 constructed from the author and the subject.
3403 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3404 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3406 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3407 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3410 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3411 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3412 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3413 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3414 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3417 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3418 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3419 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3420 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3421 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3422 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3423 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3426 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3427 entry referenced by the current line.
3430 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3431 @cindex link completion
3432 @cindex completion, of links
3433 @cindex inserting links
3434 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3435 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3436 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3437 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3438 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3439 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3440 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3441 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3442 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3443 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3444 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3445 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3446 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3447 becomes the default description.
3449 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3450 All links stored during the
3451 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3452 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3454 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3455 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3456 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3457 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3458 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3459 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3460 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3461 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3462 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3464 @cindex file name completion
3465 @cindex completion, of file names
3466 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3467 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3468 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3469 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3470 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3471 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3472 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3473 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3475 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3476 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3477 link and description parts of the link.
3479 @cindex following links
3480 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3481 @vindex org-file-apps
3482 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3483 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3484 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3485 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3486 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3487 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3488 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3489 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3490 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3491 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3492 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3493 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3494 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3495 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3496 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3497 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3500 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3501 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3508 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3509 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3513 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3514 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3515 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3516 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3518 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3519 @cindex inlining images
3520 @cindex images, inlining
3521 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3522 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3523 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3524 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3525 images that have no description part in the link, i.e.@: images that will also
3526 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3527 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3528 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3529 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3530 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3531 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3533 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3534 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3536 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3537 @cindex links, returning to
3538 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3539 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3540 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3541 previously recorded positions.
3543 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3544 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3545 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3546 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3547 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3548 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3550 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3552 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3553 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3557 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3558 @section Using links outside Org
3560 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3561 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3562 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3566 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3567 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3570 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3571 @section Link abbreviations
3572 @cindex link abbreviations
3573 @cindex abbreviation, links
3575 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3576 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3577 abbreviated link looks like this
3580 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3584 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3585 where the tag is optional.
3586 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3587 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3588 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3589 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3593 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3594 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3595 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3596 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3597 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3598 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3599 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3603 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3604 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3605 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3606 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3607 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3609 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3610 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3612 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3613 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3615 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3616 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3617 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3618 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3619 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3620 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3621 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3623 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3624 can define them in the file with
3628 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3629 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3633 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3634 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3635 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
3636 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3637 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3639 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3640 @section Search options in file links
3641 @cindex search option in file links
3642 @cindex file links, searching
3644 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3645 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3646 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3647 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3648 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3649 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3650 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3651 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3653 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3654 link, together with an explanation:
3657 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3658 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3659 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3660 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3661 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3668 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3669 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3670 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3671 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3674 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3676 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3678 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3679 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3680 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3681 sparse tree with the matches.
3682 @c If the target file is a directory,
3683 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3686 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3687 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3688 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3689 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3691 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3692 @section Custom Searches
3693 @cindex custom search strings
3694 @cindex search strings, custom
3696 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3697 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3698 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3699 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3700 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3703 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3704 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3705 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3706 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3707 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3708 to be added to the hook variables
3709 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3710 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3711 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3712 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3713 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3715 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3719 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3720 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3721 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3722 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3723 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3724 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3725 item emerged is always present.
3727 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3728 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3729 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3732 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3733 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3734 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3735 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3736 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3737 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3740 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3741 @section Basic TODO functionality
3743 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3744 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3747 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3751 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3754 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3755 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3756 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3759 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3760 '--------------------------------'
3763 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3764 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3766 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3767 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3768 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3769 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3772 @kindex S-@key{right}
3773 @kindex S-@key{left}
3774 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3775 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3776 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3777 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3778 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3779 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3780 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3781 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3782 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3783 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3784 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3785 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3786 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3787 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3788 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3789 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3790 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3791 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3792 both un-done and done.
3793 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3794 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3795 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3796 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3797 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3798 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3799 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3800 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3804 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3805 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3806 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3808 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3809 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3810 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3812 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3813 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3814 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3815 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3816 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3819 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3820 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3823 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3824 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3825 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3826 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3827 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3828 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3829 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3832 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3833 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3834 @cindex TODO workflow
3835 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3837 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3838 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3839 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3843 (setq org-todo-keywords
3844 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3847 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3848 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3849 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3851 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3852 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3853 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3854 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3855 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3856 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3857 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3858 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3859 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3860 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3861 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3863 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3864 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3866 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3867 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3869 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3870 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3871 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3872 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3873 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3874 be set up like this:
3877 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3880 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3881 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3882 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3883 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3884 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3885 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3886 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3887 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3888 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3889 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3890 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3891 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3892 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3893 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3895 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3896 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3897 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3899 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3900 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3901 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3902 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3903 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3907 (setq org-todo-keywords
3908 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3909 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3910 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3913 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3914 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3915 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3916 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3917 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3918 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3919 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3922 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3923 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3924 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3925 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3926 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3927 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3928 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3929 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3930 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3931 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3932 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3933 @kindex S-@key{right}
3934 @kindex S-@key{left}
3937 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3938 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3939 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3940 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3941 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3944 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3945 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3947 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3948 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3949 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3950 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3951 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3954 (setq org-todo-keywords
3955 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3956 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3957 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3960 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3961 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3962 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3963 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3964 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3965 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3966 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3967 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3969 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3970 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3971 @cindex keyword options
3972 @cindex per-file keywords
3977 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3978 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3979 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3980 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3981 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3985 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3987 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3988 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3990 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3993 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3997 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
4001 @cindex completion, of option keywords
4003 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
4004 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
4006 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4007 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4008 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4009 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4010 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4011 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4012 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4013 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4014 for the current buffer.}.
4016 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
4017 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4018 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4020 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4021 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4022 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4023 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4024 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4025 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4026 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4027 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
4028 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4032 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4033 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4034 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4038 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4039 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4040 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4041 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4042 foreground or a background color.
4044 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4045 @subsection TODO dependencies
4046 @cindex TODO dependencies
4047 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4049 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4050 @cindex property, ORDERED
4051 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4052 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4053 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
4054 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4055 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4056 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4057 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
4058 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4059 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
4063 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4072 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4073 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4077 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4078 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4079 @cindex property, ORDERED
4080 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4081 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4082 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4083 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4084 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4085 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4086 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4089 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4090 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4091 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4092 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4094 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4095 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4096 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4097 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4098 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4099 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4101 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4102 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4103 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4106 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4107 @section Progress logging
4108 @cindex progress logging
4109 @cindex logging, of progress
4111 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4112 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4113 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4114 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4115 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4119 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4120 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4121 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4124 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4125 @subsection Closing items
4127 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4128 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4129 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4132 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4136 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4137 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4138 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4139 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4140 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4141 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4144 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4148 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4149 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4151 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4152 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4153 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4154 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4156 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4157 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4158 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4160 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4161 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4162 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4163 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4164 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4165 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4166 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4167 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4168 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4169 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4170 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4171 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4172 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4173 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4174 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4175 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4177 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4178 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4179 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4180 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4184 (setq org-todo-keywords
4185 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4188 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4189 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4192 @vindex org-log-done
4193 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4194 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4195 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4196 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4197 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4198 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4199 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4200 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4201 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4202 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4203 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4204 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4205 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4206 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4207 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4210 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4213 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4216 @cindex property, LOGGING
4217 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4218 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4219 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4220 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4221 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4222 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4225 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4227 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4229 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4231 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4233 * TODO No logging at all
4239 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4240 @subsection Tracking your habits
4243 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4244 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4248 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4251 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4253 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4255 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4256 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4257 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4258 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4260 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4261 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4262 three days, but at most every two days.
4264 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
4265 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not
4266 enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
4270 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4271 actual habit with some history:
4275 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4276 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4277 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4278 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4279 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4280 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4281 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4282 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4283 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4284 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4285 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4288 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4292 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4293 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4294 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4295 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4296 after four days have elapsed.
4298 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4299 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4300 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4301 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4305 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4307 If the task could have been done on that day.
4309 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4311 If the task was overdue on that day.
4314 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4315 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4316 the current day falls in the graph.
4318 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4319 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4322 @item org-habit-graph-column
4323 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4324 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4325 titles brief and to the point.
4326 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4327 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4328 @item org-habit-following-days
4329 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4330 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4331 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4335 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4336 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4337 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4338 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4340 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4344 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4345 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4346 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4349 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4353 @vindex org-priority-faces
4354 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4355 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4356 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4357 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4358 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4359 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4361 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4367 @findex org-priority
4368 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4369 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4370 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4371 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4372 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4374 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4375 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4376 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4377 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4378 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4379 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4380 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4383 @vindex org-highest-priority
4384 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4385 @vindex org-default-priority
4386 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4387 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4388 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4389 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4390 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4393 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4398 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4399 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4400 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4401 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4403 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4404 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4405 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4406 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4407 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4408 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4409 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4410 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4411 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4414 * Organize Party [33%]
4415 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4419 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4422 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4423 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4424 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4425 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4428 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4429 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4430 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4431 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4432 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4436 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4438 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4442 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4443 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4446 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4447 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4448 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4449 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4451 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4455 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4456 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4459 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4463 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4464 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4465 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4466 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4467 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4468 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4469 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4470 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4471 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4472 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4474 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4477 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4478 - [-] call people [1/3]
4483 - [ ] think about what music to play
4484 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4487 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4488 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4489 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4492 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4493 @cindex checkbox statistics
4494 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4495 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4496 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4497 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4498 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4499 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4500 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4501 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4502 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4503 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4504 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4505 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4506 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4507 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4508 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4509 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4510 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4511 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4512 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4514 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4515 @cindex checkbox blocking
4516 @cindex property, ORDERED
4517 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4518 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4519 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4521 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4524 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4525 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4526 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4527 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4528 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4529 considered to be an intermediate state.
4530 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4531 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4532 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4536 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4537 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4538 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4540 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4541 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4543 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4545 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4546 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4547 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4548 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4549 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4550 @cindex property, ORDERED
4551 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4552 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4553 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4554 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4555 for better visibility, customize the variable
4556 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4557 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4558 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4559 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4560 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4561 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4562 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4563 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4566 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4569 @cindex headline tagging
4570 @cindex matching, tags
4571 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4573 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4574 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4577 @vindex org-tag-faces
4578 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4579 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4580 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4581 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4582 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4583 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4584 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4585 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4588 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4589 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4590 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4593 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4594 @section Tag inheritance
4595 @cindex tag inheritance
4596 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4597 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4599 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4600 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4601 well. For example, in the list
4604 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4605 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4606 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4610 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4611 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4612 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4613 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4614 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4615 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4616 changes in the line.}:
4620 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4624 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4625 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4626 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4627 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4628 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4630 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4631 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4632 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4633 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4634 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4635 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4636 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4637 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4639 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4640 @section Setting tags
4641 @cindex setting tags
4642 @cindex tags, setting
4645 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4646 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4647 also a special command for inserting tags:
4650 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4651 @cindex completion, of tags
4652 @vindex org-tags-column
4653 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4654 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4655 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4656 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4657 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4658 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4659 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4660 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4661 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4664 @vindex org-tag-alist
4665 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4666 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4667 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4668 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4669 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4673 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4674 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4677 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4678 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4679 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4685 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4686 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4687 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4688 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4689 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4690 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4696 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4697 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4698 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4699 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4700 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4701 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4702 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4703 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4707 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4710 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4711 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4714 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4717 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4718 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4719 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4722 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4725 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4728 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4729 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4733 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4737 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4740 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4741 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4743 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4744 these lines to activate any changes.
4747 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4748 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4749 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4750 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4754 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4755 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4756 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4758 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4761 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4762 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4763 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4764 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4765 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4770 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4771 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4772 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4775 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4776 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4777 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4781 Clear all tags for this line.
4784 Accept the modified set.
4786 Abort without installing changes.
4788 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4790 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4791 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4793 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4794 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4799 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4800 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4801 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4802 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4803 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4804 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4805 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4806 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4808 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4809 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4810 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4811 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4812 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4813 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4814 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4815 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4816 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4817 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4818 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4820 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4821 @section Tag searches
4822 @cindex tag searches
4823 @cindex searching for tags
4825 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4826 information into special lists.
4829 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4830 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4831 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4832 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4833 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4834 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4835 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4836 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4837 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4838 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4839 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4842 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4843 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4844 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4845 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4846 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4847 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4848 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4851 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4852 @chapter Properties and columns
4855 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4856 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4857 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4859 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4860 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4861 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4862 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4863 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4864 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4865 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4866 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4867 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4869 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4870 (@pxref{Column view}).
4873 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4874 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4875 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4876 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4877 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4878 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4881 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4882 @section Property syntax
4883 @cindex property syntax
4884 @cindex drawer, for properties
4886 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4887 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4888 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4889 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4890 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4895 *** Goldberg Variations
4897 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4898 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4900 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4905 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4906 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4907 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4909 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4910 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4911 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4912 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4913 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4914 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4915 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4920 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4921 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4925 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4926 file, use a line like
4927 @cindex property, _ALL
4930 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4933 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4934 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4935 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4938 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4939 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4942 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4943 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4944 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4952 *** Goldberg Variations
4954 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4955 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4957 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4962 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4964 @vindex org-global-properties
4965 Property values set with the global variable
4966 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4970 The following commands help to work with properties:
4973 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4974 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4975 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4976 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4977 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4978 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4979 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4980 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4981 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4982 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4983 information like deadlines.
4984 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4985 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4986 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4987 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4988 can be inserted using completion.
4989 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4990 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4991 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4992 Remove a property from the current entry.
4993 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4994 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4995 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4996 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4997 nearest column format definition.
5000 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
5001 @section Special properties
5002 @cindex properties, special
5004 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
5005 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5006 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
5007 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
5008 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
5009 used as keys in the properties drawer:
5011 @cindex property, special, ID
5012 @cindex property, special, TODO
5013 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5014 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5015 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
5016 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5017 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5018 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5019 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5020 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5021 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5022 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5023 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5024 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5025 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5026 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5027 @cindex property, special, FILE
5029 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5030 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5031 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5032 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5033 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5034 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5035 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5036 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5037 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5038 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5039 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5040 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5041 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5042 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5043 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5044 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5045 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5046 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5047 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5048 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5051 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5052 @section Property searches
5053 @cindex properties, searching
5054 @cindex searching, of properties
5056 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5057 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5059 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
5060 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5061 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5062 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5063 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5064 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5065 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5066 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5067 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5068 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5069 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5072 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5075 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5080 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5081 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5082 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5083 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5084 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5087 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5088 @section Property Inheritance
5089 @cindex properties, inheritance
5090 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5092 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5093 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5094 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5095 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5096 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5097 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5098 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5099 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5100 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5101 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5102 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5103 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5104 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5106 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5107 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5109 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5112 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5113 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5114 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5115 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5116 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5118 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5119 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5120 applies to the entire subtree.
5122 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5123 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5124 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5126 @cindex property, LOGGING
5127 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5128 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5131 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5132 @section Column view
5134 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5135 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5136 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5137 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5138 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5139 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5140 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5141 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5142 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5143 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5144 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5145 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5146 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5149 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5150 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5151 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5154 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5155 @subsection Defining columns
5156 @cindex column view, for properties
5157 @cindex properties, column view
5159 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5160 done by defining a column format line.
5163 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5164 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5167 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5168 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5170 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5174 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5177 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5178 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5181 ** Top node for columns view
5183 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5187 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5188 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5189 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5190 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5191 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5192 deeper part of the tree.
5194 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5195 @subsubsection Column attributes
5196 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5197 definition looks like this:
5200 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5204 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5205 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5208 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5209 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5210 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5211 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5212 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5213 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5215 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5216 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5217 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5218 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5219 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5220 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5221 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5222 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5223 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5224 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5225 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5226 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5227 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5228 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5229 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5230 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5231 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5232 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5233 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5234 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5238 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5239 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5240 same summary information.
5242 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5243 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5244 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5245 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5246 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5247 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5249 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5250 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5251 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5252 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5253 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5254 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5255 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5256 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5258 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5262 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5263 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5264 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5265 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5266 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5270 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5271 item itself, i.e.@: of the headline. You probably always should start the
5272 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5273 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5274 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5275 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5276 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5277 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5278 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5279 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5280 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5281 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5282 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5283 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5286 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5287 @subsection Using column view
5290 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5291 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5292 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5293 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5294 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5295 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5296 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5297 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5298 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5299 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5300 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5301 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5302 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5303 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5304 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5306 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5308 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5309 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5310 Move through the column view from field to field.
5311 @kindex S-@key{left}
5312 @kindex S-@key{right}
5313 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5314 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5315 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5317 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5318 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5319 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5320 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5321 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5322 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5323 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5324 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5325 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5326 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5327 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5328 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5329 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5330 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5331 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5332 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5333 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5334 current column view.
5335 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5336 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5337 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5338 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5339 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5340 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5341 Delete the current column.
5344 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5345 @subsection Capturing column view
5347 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5348 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5349 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5350 of this block looks like this:
5352 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5355 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5360 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5364 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5365 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5366 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5367 capture, you can use 4 values:
5368 @cindex property, ID
5370 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5371 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5372 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5373 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5374 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5375 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5376 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5377 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5380 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5381 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5383 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5385 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5386 @item :skip-empty-rows
5387 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5388 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5393 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5396 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5397 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5398 for the scope or ID of the view.
5399 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5400 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5401 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5402 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5403 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5404 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5408 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5409 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5410 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5411 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5413 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5414 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5415 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5416 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5417 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5418 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5419 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5421 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5422 @section The Property API
5423 @cindex properties, API
5424 @cindex API, for properties
5426 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5427 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5428 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5431 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5432 @chapter Dates and times
5438 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5439 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5440 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5441 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5442 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5443 is used in a much wider sense.
5446 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5447 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5448 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5449 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5450 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5451 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5452 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5456 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5457 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5459 @cindex ranges, time
5464 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5465 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5466 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5467 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5468 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5469 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5470 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5471 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5472 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5473 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5476 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5479 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5480 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5481 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5482 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5485 * Meet Peter at the movies
5486 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5487 * Discussion on climate change
5488 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5491 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5492 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5493 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5494 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5495 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5496 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5499 * Pick up Sam at school
5500 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5503 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5504 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5505 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5506 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5507 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5508 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5509 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5510 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5511 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5512 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5513 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5514 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5515 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5516 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5517 example with optional time
5520 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5521 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5524 @item Time/Date range
5527 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5528 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5529 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5532 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5533 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5536 @item Inactive timestamp
5537 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5538 @cindex inactive timestamp
5539 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5540 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5541 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5544 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5550 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5551 @section Creating timestamps
5552 @cindex creating timestamps
5553 @cindex timestamps, creating
5555 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5556 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5560 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5561 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5562 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5563 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5564 succession, a time range is inserted.
5566 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5567 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5574 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5575 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5576 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5577 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5580 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5582 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5583 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5585 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5586 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5587 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5590 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5591 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5592 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5594 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5595 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5596 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5598 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5599 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5600 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5601 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5602 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5603 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5604 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5605 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5606 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5608 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5609 @cindex evaluate time range
5610 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5611 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5612 the following column).
5617 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5618 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5621 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5622 @subsection The date/time prompt
5623 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5624 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5626 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5627 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5628 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5629 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5630 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5631 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5632 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5633 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5634 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5635 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5636 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5637 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5638 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5639 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5640 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5641 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5642 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5643 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5645 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5646 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5650 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5651 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5652 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5653 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5654 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5655 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5656 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5657 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5658 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5659 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5660 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5661 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5662 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5663 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5666 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5667 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5668 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5669 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5670 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5671 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5672 the Nth such day, e.g.@:
5677 +4d @result{} four days from today
5678 +4 @result{} same as above
5679 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5680 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5681 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5684 @vindex parse-time-months
5685 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5686 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5687 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5688 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5690 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5691 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5692 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5693 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5694 read the docstring of the variable
5695 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5697 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5698 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5699 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5703 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5704 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5705 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5708 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5709 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5710 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5711 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5712 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5713 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5714 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5715 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5716 from the minibuffer:
5723 @kindex S-@key{right}
5724 @kindex S-@key{left}
5725 @kindex S-@key{down}
5727 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5728 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5731 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5732 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5733 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5734 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5735 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5736 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5737 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5740 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5741 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5742 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5743 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5744 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5745 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5746 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5748 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5749 @subsection Custom time format
5750 @cindex custom date/time format
5751 @cindex time format, custom
5752 @cindex date format, custom
5754 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5755 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5756 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5757 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5758 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5759 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5760 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5763 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5764 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5768 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5769 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5770 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5771 following consequences:
5774 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5777 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5778 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5779 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5780 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5781 time will be changed by one minute.
5783 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5784 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5786 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5787 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5788 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5790 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5791 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5792 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5796 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5797 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5799 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5803 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5805 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5806 to be finished on that date.
5808 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5809 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5810 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5811 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5812 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5813 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5816 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5817 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5818 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5821 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5822 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5823 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5826 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5828 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5831 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5832 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5833 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5834 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5835 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5836 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.@:
5837 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5840 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5841 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5845 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5846 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5847 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5848 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5849 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5850 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5851 want to start working on an action item.
5854 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5855 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5856 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5857 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5859 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5861 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5862 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5863 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5867 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5868 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5871 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5872 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5874 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5875 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5876 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5881 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5882 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5883 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5884 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5885 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5886 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5887 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5890 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5891 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5892 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5893 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5894 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5895 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5896 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5897 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5900 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5903 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5904 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5905 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5906 schedule the marked item.
5908 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5909 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5910 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5911 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5912 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5913 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5914 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5915 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5917 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5918 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5920 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5921 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5924 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5925 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g. +1d will set
5926 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5927 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5929 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5930 @subsection Repeated tasks
5931 @cindex tasks, repeated
5932 @cindex repeated tasks
5934 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5935 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5936 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5938 ** TODO Pay the rent
5939 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5942 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5943 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5944 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5945 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5946 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5947 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5949 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5950 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5951 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5952 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5953 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5954 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5955 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5956 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5957 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5958 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5959 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5960 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5961 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5962 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5963 switch the date like this:
5966 ** TODO Pay the rent
5967 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5970 @vindex org-log-repeat
5971 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5972 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5973 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5974 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5975 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5977 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5978 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5981 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5982 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5983 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5984 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5985 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5986 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5987 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5988 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5989 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5993 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5994 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5995 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5996 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5997 and marked it done on Saturday.
5998 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5999 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
6000 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
6004 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
6005 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
6007 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6008 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6009 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6012 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
6013 @section Clocking work time
6014 @cindex clocking time
6015 @cindex time clocking
6017 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6018 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6019 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6020 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6021 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6022 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6023 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6024 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6025 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6027 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6029 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6030 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6032 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6033 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6034 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6035 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6039 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6040 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6041 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6044 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6045 @subsection Clocking commands
6048 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6049 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6050 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6051 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6052 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6053 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6054 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6055 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6056 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6057 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6058 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6059 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6060 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6061 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6062 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6063 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6064 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6065 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6066 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6067 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6068 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6069 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6070 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6071 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6072 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6073 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6074 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6075 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6076 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6077 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6078 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6079 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6080 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6081 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6082 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6083 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6085 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6086 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6087 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6088 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6089 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6090 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6091 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6092 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6093 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6094 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6095 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6096 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6097 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6098 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6100 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6101 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6104 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6105 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6106 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6107 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6108 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6109 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6110 clock duration keeps the same.
6111 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6112 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6113 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6114 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6115 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6116 increased by five minutes.
6117 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6118 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6119 if it is running in this same item.
6120 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6121 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6122 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6123 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6124 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6125 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6126 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6127 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6128 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6129 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6130 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6131 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6132 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6136 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6137 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6138 worked on or closed during a day.
6140 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6141 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6142 modify the window disposition.
6144 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6145 @subsection The clock table
6146 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6147 @cindex report, of clocked time
6149 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6150 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6151 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6154 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6155 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6156 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6157 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6158 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6159 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6160 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6161 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6162 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6163 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6164 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6165 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6166 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6167 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6168 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6169 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6170 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6174 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6175 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6177 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6179 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6183 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6184 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6185 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6186 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6188 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6191 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6192 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6193 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6194 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6195 file @r{the full current buffer}
6196 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6197 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6198 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6199 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6200 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6201 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6202 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6203 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6204 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6206 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6207 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6208 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6209 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6210 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6211 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6212 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6213 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6214 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6215 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6216 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6217 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6218 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6219 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6220 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6221 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6222 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6223 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6226 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6227 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6228 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6230 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6231 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6232 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6233 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6234 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6235 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6236 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6237 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6238 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6239 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6240 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6241 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6242 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6243 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6244 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6245 @r{property will get its own column.}
6246 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6247 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6248 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6249 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6250 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6251 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6253 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6254 day, you could write
6256 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6260 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6261 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6262 only to fit it into the manual.}
6264 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6265 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6268 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6270 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6273 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6276 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6280 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6281 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6283 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6284 @cindex resolve idle time
6286 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6287 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6288 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6289 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6290 applying it to another one.
6292 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6293 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6294 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6295 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6296 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6297 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6298 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6299 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6300 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6301 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6302 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6303 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6307 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6308 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6309 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6311 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6312 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6313 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6315 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6316 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6318 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6319 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6320 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6322 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6323 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6324 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6325 log with an empty entry.
6328 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6329 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6330 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6331 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6332 the next task you clock in on.
6334 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6335 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6336 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6337 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6338 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6340 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6341 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6342 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6343 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6344 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6345 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6347 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6348 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6350 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6351 @cindex continuous clocking
6352 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6354 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6355 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6356 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6357 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6359 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6360 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6362 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6363 @section Effort estimates
6364 @cindex effort estimates
6366 @cindex property, Effort
6367 @vindex org-effort-property
6368 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6369 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6370 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6371 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6372 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6373 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6374 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6375 for an entry with the following commands:
6378 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6379 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6380 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6381 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6382 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6383 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6386 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6387 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6388 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6389 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6393 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6394 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6398 @vindex org-global-properties
6399 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6400 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6401 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6402 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6403 setup may be advised.
6405 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6406 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6407 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6408 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6410 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6411 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6412 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6413 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6414 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6415 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6416 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6417 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6418 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6420 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6421 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6422 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6423 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6425 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6426 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6427 @cindex relative timer
6429 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6430 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6431 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6434 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6435 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6436 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6438 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6439 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6440 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6441 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6442 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6444 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6447 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6448 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6449 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6450 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6452 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6453 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6454 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6455 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6456 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6457 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6458 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6459 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6460 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6461 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6462 not started at exactly the right moment.
6465 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6466 @section Countdown timer
6467 @cindex Countdown timer
6471 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6472 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6474 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6475 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6476 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6479 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6480 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6483 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6484 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6485 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6486 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6487 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6488 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6491 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6492 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6493 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6494 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6495 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6496 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6499 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6503 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6504 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6505 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6506 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6507 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6509 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6510 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6512 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6514 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6515 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6516 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6517 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6519 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6520 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6521 does enhance it with templates and more.
6524 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6525 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6526 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6529 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6530 @subsection Setting up capture
6532 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6533 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6534 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6536 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6538 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6539 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6542 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6543 @subsection Using capture
6546 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6547 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6548 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6550 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6551 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6552 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6553 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6555 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6556 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6557 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6558 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6559 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6561 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6562 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6563 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6564 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6565 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6566 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6567 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6569 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6570 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6574 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6575 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6576 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6577 rather than to the current date.
6579 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6584 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6585 template in the usual way.
6586 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6587 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6590 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6591 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6592 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6593 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6596 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6597 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6599 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6600 @subsection Capture templates
6601 @cindex templates, for Capture
6603 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6604 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6605 through the customize interface.
6609 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6612 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6613 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6614 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6615 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6616 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6620 (setq org-capture-templates
6621 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6622 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6623 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6624 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6627 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6631 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6635 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6636 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6637 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6638 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6639 place where you started the capture process.
6641 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6642 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6646 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6647 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6651 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6652 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6653 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6656 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6657 @subsubsection Template elements
6659 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6660 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6664 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6665 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6666 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6667 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6668 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6669 prefix key, for example
6671 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6673 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6674 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6677 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6681 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6684 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6685 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6687 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6688 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6690 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6693 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6694 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6695 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6697 Text to be inserted as it is.
6701 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6702 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6703 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6704 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6705 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6706 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6707 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6711 @item (file "path/to/file")
6712 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6714 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6715 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6717 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6718 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6720 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6721 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6723 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6724 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6726 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6727 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6729 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6730 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6732 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6733 A function to find the right location in the file.
6736 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6738 @item (function function-finding-location)
6739 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6744 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6745 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6746 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6747 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6748 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6752 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6753 Recognized properties are:
6756 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6757 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6758 Setting this property will change that.
6760 @item :immediate-finish
6761 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6762 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6763 information that can be added automatically.
6766 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6767 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6770 Start the clock in this item.
6773 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6776 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6777 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6778 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6779 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6782 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6783 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6785 @item :table-line-pos
6786 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6787 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6788 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6792 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6793 buffer again after capture is completed.
6797 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6798 @subsubsection Template expansion
6800 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6801 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6802 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6805 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6806 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6807 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6808 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6809 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6810 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6811 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6812 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6813 @r{region is active.}
6814 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6815 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6816 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6817 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6818 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6819 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6820 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6821 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6822 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6823 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6824 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6825 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6826 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6827 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6828 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6829 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6830 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6831 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6832 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6833 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6834 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6835 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6836 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6837 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6838 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6839 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6843 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6844 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6845 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6846 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6849 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6851 Link type | Available keywords
6852 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6853 bbdb | %:name %:company
6854 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6855 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6856 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6857 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6858 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6859 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6860 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6861 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6862 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6864 info | %:file %:node
6869 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6872 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6875 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6876 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6878 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6879 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6880 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6881 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6882 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6885 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6886 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6889 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6890 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6893 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6894 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6897 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6899 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6900 @section Attachments
6903 @vindex org-attach-directory
6904 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6905 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6906 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6907 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6908 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6909 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6910 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6911 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6912 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6913 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6914 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6915 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6916 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6918 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6919 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6920 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6923 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6927 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6928 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6929 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6930 to select a command:
6933 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6934 @vindex org-attach-method
6935 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6936 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6937 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6943 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6944 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6946 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6947 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6949 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6950 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6951 attachments yourself.
6953 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6954 @vindex org-file-apps
6955 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6956 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6957 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6958 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6960 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6961 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6963 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6964 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6966 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6967 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6969 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6970 Select and delete a single attachment.
6972 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6973 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6974 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6976 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6977 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6978 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6979 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6981 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6982 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6983 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6984 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6988 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6993 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6994 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6995 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6996 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6997 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6998 information. Here is just an example:
7001 (setq org-feed-alist
7003 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
7004 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
7008 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7009 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7010 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7011 the following command is used:
7014 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7016 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7018 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7019 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7022 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7023 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7024 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7025 list of drawers in that file:
7028 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7031 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7032 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7034 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7035 @section Protocols for external access
7036 @cindex protocols, for external access
7039 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7040 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7041 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7042 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7043 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7044 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7045 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7046 documentation and setup instructions.
7048 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7049 @section Refiling notes
7050 @cindex refiling notes
7052 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7053 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7054 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7055 process, you can use the following special command:
7058 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7059 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7060 @vindex org-refile-targets
7061 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7062 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7063 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7064 @vindex org-log-refile
7065 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7066 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7067 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7068 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7069 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7071 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7072 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7073 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7074 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7075 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7076 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7077 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7078 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7079 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7080 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7081 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7082 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7083 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7084 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7085 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7086 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7088 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7089 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7090 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7091 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7092 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7095 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7099 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7100 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7101 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7102 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7105 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7106 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7107 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7108 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7112 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7113 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7116 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7117 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7118 @cindex external archiving
7120 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7124 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7125 @vindex org-archive-location
7126 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7127 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7128 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7129 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7130 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7131 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7132 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7133 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7136 @cindex archive locations
7137 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7138 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7139 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7140 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7141 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7142 see the documentation string of the variable
7143 @code{org-archive-location}.
7145 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7146 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7147 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7148 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7149 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7150 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7151 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7152 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7156 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7159 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7161 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7162 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7163 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7165 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7166 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7167 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7168 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7169 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7173 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7174 @subsection Internal archiving
7176 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7177 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7179 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7180 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7183 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7184 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7185 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7186 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7187 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7188 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7190 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7191 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7192 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7193 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7195 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7196 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7197 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7198 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7199 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7200 temporarily included.
7202 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7203 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7204 is. Configure the details using the variable
7205 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7207 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7208 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7209 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7212 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7215 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7216 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7217 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7219 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7220 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7221 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7222 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7223 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7224 level 1 trees will be checked.
7225 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7226 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7227 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7228 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7229 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7230 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7231 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7236 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7237 @chapter Agenda views
7238 @cindex agenda views
7240 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7241 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7242 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7243 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7244 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7246 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7247 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7251 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7254 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7257 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7258 TODO state associated with them,
7260 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7261 in time-sorted view,
7263 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7264 that contain specified keywords,
7266 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7269 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7274 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7275 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7276 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7277 edit these files remotely.
7279 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7280 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7281 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7282 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7283 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7284 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7287 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7288 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7289 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7290 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7291 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7292 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7293 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7294 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7297 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7298 @section Agenda files
7299 @cindex agenda files
7300 @cindex files for agenda
7302 @vindex org-agenda-files
7303 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7304 files}, the files listed in the variable
7305 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7306 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7307 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7308 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7311 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7312 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7313 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7314 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7315 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7316 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7318 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7320 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7321 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7322 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7323 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7324 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7325 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7327 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7328 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7330 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7331 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7332 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7333 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7338 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7339 to visit any of them.
7341 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7342 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7343 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7344 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7345 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7346 extended period, use the following commands:
7349 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7350 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7351 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7352 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7353 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7354 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7355 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7356 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7357 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7361 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7364 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7365 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7366 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7367 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7369 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7370 Lift the restriction.
7373 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7374 @section The agenda dispatcher
7375 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7376 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7377 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7378 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7379 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7380 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7381 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7382 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7385 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7387 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7389 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7390 tags and properties}).
7392 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7394 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7395 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7397 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7398 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7399 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7400 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7401 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7404 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7406 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7407 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7408 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7409 selecting the command.
7411 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7412 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7413 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7414 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7415 character selecting the command.
7418 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7419 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7420 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7421 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7422 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7423 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7424 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7425 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7426 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7429 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7430 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7431 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7432 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7433 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7435 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7436 @section The built-in agenda views
7438 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7441 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7442 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7443 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7444 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7445 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7446 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7449 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7450 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7452 @cindex weekly agenda
7453 @cindex daily agenda
7455 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7456 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7459 @cindex org-agenda, command
7460 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7461 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7462 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7463 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7464 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7465 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7466 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7469 @vindex org-agenda-span
7470 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7471 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7472 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7473 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7474 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7477 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7478 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7479 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7482 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7483 @cindex calendar integration
7484 @cindex diary integration
7486 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7487 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7488 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7489 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7490 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7491 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7494 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7495 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7498 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7501 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7502 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7503 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7504 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7505 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7506 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7507 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7508 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7509 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7510 between calendar and agenda.
7512 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7513 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7514 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7515 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7516 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7517 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7518 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7519 will be made in the agenda:
7522 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7524 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7526 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7527 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7530 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7531 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7532 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7534 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7535 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7536 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7537 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7538 following to one of your agenda files:
7545 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7548 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7549 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7550 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7551 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7552 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7553 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7554 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7560 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7563 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7564 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7565 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7566 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7567 in an Org or Diary file.
7569 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7570 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7571 @cindex appointment reminders
7575 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7576 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7577 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7578 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7579 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7580 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7581 docstring for details.
7583 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7584 @subsection The global TODO list
7585 @cindex global TODO list
7586 @cindex TODO list, global
7588 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7589 collected into a single place.
7592 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7593 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7594 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7595 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7596 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7597 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7598 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7599 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7600 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7601 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7602 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7603 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7604 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7605 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7607 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7608 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7609 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7610 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7611 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7612 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7615 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7616 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7617 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7619 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7620 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7621 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7625 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7626 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7627 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7628 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7629 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7630 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7631 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7632 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7633 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7634 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7637 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7638 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7639 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7640 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7641 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7644 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7645 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7646 @cindex matching, of tags
7647 @cindex matching, of properties
7651 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7652 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7653 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7654 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7658 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7659 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7660 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7661 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7662 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7663 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7664 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7665 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7666 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7667 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7668 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7669 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7670 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7671 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7675 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7678 @subsubheading Match syntax
7680 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7681 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7682 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7683 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7684 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7685 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7686 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7687 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7688 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7692 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7695 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7696 @item work|laptop+night
7697 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7701 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7702 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7703 braces. For example,
7704 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7705 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7707 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7708 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7709 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7710 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7711 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7712 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7713 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7714 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7715 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7716 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7717 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7718 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7719 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7720 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7721 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7722 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7724 Here are more examples:
7726 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7727 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7728 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7729 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7730 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7733 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7734 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7737 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7738 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7742 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7745 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7746 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7747 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7749 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7750 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7752 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7753 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7754 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7755 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7756 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7757 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.@: without a time
7758 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7759 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7760 respectively, can be used.
7762 If the comparison value is enclosed
7763 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7764 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7768 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7769 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7770 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7771 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7772 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7773 on or after October 11, 2008.
7775 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7776 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7777 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7780 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7781 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7782 inheritance}, for details.
7784 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7785 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7786 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7787 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7788 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7789 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7790 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7791 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7792 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7793 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7794 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7795 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7799 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7800 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7801 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7803 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7804 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7808 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7809 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7810 @cindex timeline, single file
7811 @cindex time-sorted view
7813 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7814 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7815 to give an overview over events in a project.
7818 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7819 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7820 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7821 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7825 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7826 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7828 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7829 @subsection Search view
7832 @cindex searching, for text
7834 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7835 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7838 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7839 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7840 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7842 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7843 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7844 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7845 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7846 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7847 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7848 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7849 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7850 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7851 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7852 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7854 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7855 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7856 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7858 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7859 @subsection Stuck projects
7860 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7862 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7863 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7864 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7865 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7866 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7867 projects and define next actions for them.
7870 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7871 List projects that are stuck.
7874 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7875 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7876 project is and how to find it.
7879 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7880 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7881 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7882 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7884 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7885 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7886 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7887 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7888 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7889 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7890 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7891 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7892 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7893 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7894 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7895 correct customization for this is
7898 (setq org-stuck-projects
7899 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7903 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7904 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7906 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7907 @section Presentation and sorting
7908 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7910 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7911 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7912 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7913 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7914 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7915 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7916 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7917 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7918 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7919 associated with the item.
7922 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7923 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7924 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7927 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7928 @subsection Categories
7932 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7933 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7934 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7935 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7936 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7937 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7938 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7939 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7940 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7948 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7949 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7950 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7951 special category you want to apply as the value.
7954 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7955 longer than 10 characters.
7958 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7959 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7961 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7962 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7963 @cindex time-of-day specification
7965 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7966 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7967 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7968 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7970 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7972 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7973 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7974 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7975 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7977 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7978 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7979 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7982 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7983 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7984 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7985 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7989 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7990 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7993 8:00...... ------------------
7994 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7995 10:00...... ------------------
7996 12:00...... ------------------
7997 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7998 14:00...... ------------------
7999 16:00...... ------------------
8000 18:00...... ------------------
8001 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8002 20:00...... ------------------
8003 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8006 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8007 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8008 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8009 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8010 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8012 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
8013 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
8014 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8015 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8016 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8017 done depends on the type of view.
8020 @vindex org-agenda-files
8021 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8022 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8023 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8024 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8025 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8026 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8027 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8028 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8029 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8031 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8032 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8033 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8034 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8037 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8038 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8041 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8042 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8043 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8044 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8046 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8047 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8048 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8050 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8051 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8052 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8053 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8054 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8055 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8057 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8058 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8061 @tsubheading{Motion}
8062 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8063 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8064 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8065 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8066 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8067 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8068 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8069 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8070 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8071 outline, not only the heading.
8073 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8074 Display original location and recenter that window.
8076 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8077 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8079 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8080 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8082 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8083 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8084 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8085 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8086 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8087 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8088 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8090 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8091 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8092 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8093 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8094 previously used indirect buffer.
8096 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8097 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8098 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8099 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8101 @tsubheading{Change display}
8102 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8105 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8109 Delete other windows.
8111 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8112 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8113 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8114 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8115 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8116 @vindex org-agenda-span
8117 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8118 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8119 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8120 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8121 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8122 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8123 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8124 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8125 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8126 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8127 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8129 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8130 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8131 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8132 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8134 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8135 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8137 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8140 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8141 Prompt for a date and go there.
8143 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8144 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8146 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8147 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8149 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8151 @vindex org-log-done
8152 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8153 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8154 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8155 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8156 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8157 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8158 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8159 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8160 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8162 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8163 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8164 agenda and timeline views.
8166 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8167 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8168 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8169 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8170 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8171 press @kbd{v a} again.
8173 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8174 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8175 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8176 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8177 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8178 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8179 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8180 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8181 when toggling this mode (i.e.@: @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8182 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8183 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8184 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8187 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8188 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8189 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8190 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8191 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8192 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8195 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8196 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8197 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8198 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8199 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8200 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8201 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8202 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8204 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8205 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8206 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8207 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8208 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8210 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8211 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8212 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8213 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8214 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8216 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8219 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8220 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8223 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8224 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8225 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8226 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8227 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8228 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8229 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8230 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8232 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8233 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8234 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8236 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8237 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8238 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8239 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8240 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8241 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8243 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8244 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8246 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8247 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8248 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8251 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8252 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8253 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8254 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8255 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8256 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8257 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8258 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8259 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8260 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8261 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8263 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8264 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8265 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8266 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8267 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8268 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8269 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8270 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8271 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8272 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8274 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8275 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8276 efforts globally, for example
8278 (setq org-global-properties
8279 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8281 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8282 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8283 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8284 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8285 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
8286 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8287 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8288 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8289 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8290 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8292 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8293 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8294 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8295 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8296 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8297 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8298 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8299 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8300 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8304 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8306 ((string= tag "Net")
8307 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8308 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8309 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8310 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8311 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8314 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8318 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8319 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8320 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8321 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8322 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8331 @item @r{in} search view
8332 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8333 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8334 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8335 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8336 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8340 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8341 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8346 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8347 @cindex remote editing, undo
8348 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8349 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8350 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8352 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8353 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8356 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8357 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8358 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8360 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8361 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8362 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8363 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8364 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8365 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8367 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8368 Refile the entry at point.
8370 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8371 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8372 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8373 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8374 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8376 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8377 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8379 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8380 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8383 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8384 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8385 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8388 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8389 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8390 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8391 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8392 tags of a headline occasionally.
8394 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8395 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8396 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8400 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8401 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8402 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8404 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8405 Display weighted priority of current item.
8407 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8408 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8409 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8412 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8413 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8415 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8416 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8417 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8418 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8419 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8421 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8422 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8424 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8425 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8427 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8428 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8430 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
8431 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
8432 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
8435 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
8436 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
8437 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
8438 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
8439 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
8442 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
8445 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8446 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8447 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8449 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8450 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8451 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8452 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8453 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8454 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8455 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8457 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8458 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8461 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8462 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8463 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8465 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8466 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8469 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8470 Stop the previously started clock.
8472 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8473 Cancel the currently running clock.
8475 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8476 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8478 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8479 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8480 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8481 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8483 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8484 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8487 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8488 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8490 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8491 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8493 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8494 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8496 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8497 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8498 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8499 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8500 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8501 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8502 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8505 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8506 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8507 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8508 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8509 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8510 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8511 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8512 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8513 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8514 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8515 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8516 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8517 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8518 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8519 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8520 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8521 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8523 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8524 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8525 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8526 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8527 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8528 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8529 @r{ (save-excursion}
8530 @r{ (save-restriction}
8532 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8533 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8534 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8538 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8539 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8541 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8542 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8544 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8545 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8548 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8549 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8550 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8551 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8552 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8553 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8554 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8555 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8556 you can add the entry.
8558 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8559 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8560 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8561 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8562 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8563 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8564 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8565 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8566 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8567 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8569 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8570 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8572 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8573 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8574 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8576 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8577 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8580 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8581 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8583 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8584 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8585 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8587 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8588 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8589 @cindex exporting agenda views
8590 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8591 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8592 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8593 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8594 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8595 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8596 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8597 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8598 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8600 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8601 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8602 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8604 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8605 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8606 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8607 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8608 visit Org files will not be removed.
8612 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8613 @section Custom agenda views
8614 @cindex custom agenda views
8615 @cindex agenda views, custom
8617 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8618 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8619 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8620 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8623 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8624 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8625 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8628 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8629 @subsection Storing searches
8631 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8632 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8633 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8636 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8638 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8639 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8640 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8641 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8646 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8647 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8648 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8649 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8650 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8651 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8652 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8653 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8654 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8655 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8656 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8661 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8662 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8663 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8664 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8665 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8666 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8667 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8668 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8669 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8674 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8677 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8678 results as a sparse tree
8680 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8683 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8684 headlines that are also TODO items
8686 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8687 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8689 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8690 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8692 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8693 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8694 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8697 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8698 @subsection Block agenda
8699 @cindex block agenda
8700 @cindex agenda, with block views
8702 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8703 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8704 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8705 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8706 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8707 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8708 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8712 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8713 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8717 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8725 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8726 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8727 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8728 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8729 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8731 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8732 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8733 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8735 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8736 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8737 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8738 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8739 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8740 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8741 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8745 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8746 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8747 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8748 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8749 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8750 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8751 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8753 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8754 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8759 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8760 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8761 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8762 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8763 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8764 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8765 to only a single file.
8767 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8768 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8769 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8770 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8771 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8772 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8773 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8774 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8775 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8776 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8777 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8781 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8782 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8786 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8787 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8788 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8795 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8796 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8797 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8798 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8799 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8802 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8803 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8804 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8805 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8806 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8810 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8811 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8814 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8815 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8818 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8819 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8822 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8824 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8825 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8826 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8828 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8829 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8830 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8831 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8832 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8833 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8834 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8837 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8838 @cindex exporting agenda views
8839 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8840 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8841 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8842 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8843 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8844 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8845 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8846 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8848 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8849 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8850 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8851 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8853 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8854 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8855 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8856 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8857 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8861 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8862 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8863 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8864 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8865 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8866 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8867 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8868 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8869 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8874 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8875 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8876 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8877 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8882 ("~/views/home.html"))
8883 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8888 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8892 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8893 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8894 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8895 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8896 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8897 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8898 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8899 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8901 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8902 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8903 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8907 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8908 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8912 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8913 set options for the export commands. For example:
8916 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8918 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8919 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8920 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8921 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8922 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8927 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8928 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8929 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8930 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8931 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8932 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8933 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8934 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8935 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8938 From the command line you may also use
8940 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8943 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8944 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8946 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8947 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8948 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8949 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8950 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8954 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8955 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8958 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8959 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8963 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8964 @section Using column view in the agenda
8965 @cindex column view, in agenda
8966 @cindex agenda, column view
8968 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8969 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8970 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8971 collected by certain criteria.
8974 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8975 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8978 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8979 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8980 This causes the following issues:
8984 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8985 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8986 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8987 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8988 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8989 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8990 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8991 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8992 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8993 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8995 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8996 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8997 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8998 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8999 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
9000 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
9001 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
9002 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
9003 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
9004 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
9005 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
9006 some values will count double.
9008 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
9009 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
9010 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
9011 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
9012 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9013 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9014 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9018 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9019 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9020 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9021 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9022 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9023 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9027 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9028 @chapter Markup for rich export
9030 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9031 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9032 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9033 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9034 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9037 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9038 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9039 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9040 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9041 * Index entries:: Making an index
9042 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9043 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9046 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9047 @section Structural markup elements
9050 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9051 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9052 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9053 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9055 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9056 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9057 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9058 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9059 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9062 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9063 @subheading Document title
9064 @cindex document title, markup rules
9067 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9071 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9075 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9076 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9077 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9078 title will be the file name without extension.
9080 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9081 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9082 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9083 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9085 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9086 @subheading Headings and sections
9087 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9089 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9090 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9091 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9092 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9093 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9094 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9095 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9096 per-file basis with a line
9103 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9104 @subheading Table of contents
9105 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9107 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9108 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9109 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9110 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9111 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9112 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9113 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9114 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9117 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9118 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9121 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9122 @subheading Text before the first headline
9123 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9126 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9127 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9128 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9129 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9131 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9132 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9133 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9134 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9135 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9136 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9139 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9140 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9144 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9145 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9146 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9149 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9151 @cindex lists, markup rules
9153 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9154 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9157 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9158 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9159 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9161 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9162 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9164 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9165 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9167 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9170 Great clouds overhead
9171 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9178 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9179 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9180 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9182 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9185 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9186 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9190 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9191 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9194 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9200 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9201 @subheading Footnote markup
9202 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9203 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9205 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9206 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9207 multiple footnotes side by side.
9209 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9210 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9212 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9213 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9214 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9215 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9216 @cindex code text, markup rules
9217 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9218 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9219 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9220 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9221 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9223 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9224 @subheading Horizontal rules
9225 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9226 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9227 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9229 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9230 @subheading Comment lines
9231 @cindex comment lines
9232 @cindex exporting, not
9233 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9235 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by @samp{#}
9236 are treated as comments and will never be exported. Also entire subtrees
9237 starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally,
9238 regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will
9244 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9248 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9249 @section Images and Tables
9251 @cindex tables, markup rules
9254 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9255 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9256 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9257 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9258 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9259 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9262 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9263 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9268 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9270 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9273 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9274 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9275 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9276 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9277 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9278 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9279 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9282 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9283 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9287 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9288 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9291 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9293 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9294 @section Literal examples
9295 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9296 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9298 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9299 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9300 for source code and similar examples.
9301 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9305 Some example from a text file.
9309 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9310 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9311 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9312 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9313 whitespace before the colon:
9317 : Some example from a text file.
9320 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9321 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9322 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9323 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9324 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9325 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9326 achieved using either the listings or the
9327 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9328 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9329 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9330 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9331 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9332 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9333 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9338 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9339 (defun org-xor (a b)
9345 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9346 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9347 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9348 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9349 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9350 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e.@: the reference name
9351 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9352 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9355 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9356 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9357 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9358 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9359 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9360 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9364 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9365 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9366 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9368 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9372 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9373 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9374 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9375 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9377 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9378 areas in HTML export}).
9380 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9381 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9382 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9387 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9388 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9389 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
9390 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
9391 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
9392 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
9393 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
9394 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
9395 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
9396 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
9397 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
9401 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9402 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9403 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9404 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9405 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9409 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9410 @section Include files
9411 @cindex include files, markup rules
9413 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9414 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9418 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9421 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g.@: @samp{quote},
9422 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9423 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9424 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9425 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9426 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9427 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9428 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9429 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9433 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9436 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9437 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9438 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9442 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9443 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9444 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9450 Visit the include file at point.
9453 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9454 @section Index entries
9455 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9457 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9458 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9459 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9460 an index} for more information.
9465 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9471 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9472 @section Macro replacement
9473 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9476 You can define text snippets with
9479 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9482 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9483 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9484 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9485 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9486 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9487 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9488 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9489 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9490 @code{format-time-string}.
9492 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9493 construct complex HTML code.
9496 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9497 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9498 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9499 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9501 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9502 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9503 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9504 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9505 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9506 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9507 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9508 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9509 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9512 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9513 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9514 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9515 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9516 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9519 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9520 @subsection Special symbols
9521 @cindex math symbols
9522 @cindex special symbols
9523 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9524 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9525 @cindex HTML entities
9526 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9528 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9529 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9530 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9531 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9532 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9533 delimiters, for example:
9536 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9539 @vindex org-entities
9540 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9541 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9542 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9543 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9544 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9545 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9547 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9548 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9549 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9550 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9551 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9553 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9554 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9555 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9556 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9561 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9562 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9563 for display purposes only.
9566 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9567 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9571 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9572 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9573 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9574 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9575 with curly braces. For example
9578 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9579 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9582 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9583 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9584 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9585 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9586 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9587 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9588 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9594 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9595 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9600 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9601 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9604 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9605 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9606 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9608 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9609 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9610 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9611 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9612 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9613 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9614 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9615 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9616 @file{MathJax} on your own
9617 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9618 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9619 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9620 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9621 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9622 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9623 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9624 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9627 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9628 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9631 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9632 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9633 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9634 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9635 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9637 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9638 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9639 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9640 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9641 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9642 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9643 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9646 @noindent For example:
9649 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9650 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9651 \end@{equation@} % etc
9653 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9654 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9658 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9659 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9660 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9661 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9663 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9664 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9665 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9666 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9667 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9671 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9672 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9673 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9674 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9677 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9678 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9679 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9681 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9682 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9687 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9688 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9689 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9690 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9691 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9692 process the entire buffer.
9695 Remove the overlay preview images.
9698 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9699 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9700 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9701 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9704 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9705 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9708 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9709 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9710 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9711 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9712 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9713 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9714 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9715 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9716 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9720 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9723 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9724 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9728 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9731 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9732 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9733 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9734 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9735 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9736 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9737 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9738 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9739 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9740 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9741 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9745 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9746 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9747 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9748 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9749 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9750 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9753 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9754 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9755 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9758 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9759 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9760 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9761 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9765 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9769 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9770 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9771 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9772 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9773 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9774 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9775 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9776 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9777 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9778 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9779 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9780 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9781 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9782 these different formats.
9784 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9785 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9788 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9789 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9790 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9791 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9792 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9793 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9794 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9795 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9796 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9797 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9798 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9799 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9802 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9803 @section Selective export
9804 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9806 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9807 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9808 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9809 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9810 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9811 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9812 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9816 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9817 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9818 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9819 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9822 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9826 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9827 be removed from the export buffer.
9830 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9831 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9832 variable for more information.
9834 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9835 @section Export options
9836 @cindex options, for export
9838 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9839 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9840 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9841 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9842 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9843 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9844 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9845 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9846 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9847 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9850 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9851 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9858 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9866 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9867 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9869 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9870 @vindex user-full-name
9871 @vindex user-mail-address
9872 @vindex org-export-default-language
9873 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9875 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9876 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9877 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9878 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9879 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9880 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9881 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g.@: @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9882 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9883 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9884 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9885 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.@:: @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9886 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9887 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9888 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9889 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9890 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9891 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9892 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9896 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9897 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9898 settings. Here you can:
9899 @cindex headline levels
9900 @cindex section-numbers
9901 @cindex table of contents
9902 @cindex line-break preservation
9903 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9904 @cindex fixed-width sections
9906 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9908 @cindex special strings
9909 @cindex emphasized text
9910 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9911 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9912 @cindex author info, in export
9913 @cindex time info, in export
9914 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9915 @vindex org-export-author-info
9916 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9917 @vindex org-export-email-info
9918 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9920 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9921 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9922 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9923 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9924 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9925 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9926 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9927 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9928 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9929 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9930 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9931 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9932 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9933 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9934 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9935 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9936 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9937 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9938 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9939 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9940 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9941 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9942 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9943 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9944 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9945 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9946 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9949 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9950 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9951 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9953 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9954 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9955 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9956 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9958 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9959 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9960 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9961 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9962 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9964 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9965 @section The export dispatcher
9966 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9968 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9969 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9970 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9971 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9972 the subtrees are exported.
9975 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9976 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9977 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9978 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9979 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9980 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9981 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9982 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9983 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9984 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9985 (i.e.@: not hidden by outline visibility).
9986 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9987 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9988 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9989 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e.@: request background processing if
9990 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9993 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9994 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9995 @cindex ASCII export
9996 @cindex Latin-1 export
9997 @cindex UTF-8 export
9999 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
10000 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
10001 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
10003 @cindex region, active
10004 @cindex active region
10005 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10007 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
10008 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10009 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
10010 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
10011 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10012 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10013 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10014 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
10015 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
10016 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10018 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10019 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10020 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10021 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10022 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10023 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10024 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10025 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10026 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10027 Export only the visible part of the document.
10030 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10031 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10032 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10033 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10034 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10037 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10041 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10042 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10043 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10044 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10045 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10046 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10047 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10049 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10050 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10051 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10052 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10054 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10055 @section HTML export
10056 @cindex HTML export
10058 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10059 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10060 language, but with additional support for tables.
10063 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10064 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10065 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10066 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10067 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10068 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10069 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10070 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10071 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10072 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10075 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10076 @subsection HTML export commands
10078 @cindex region, active
10079 @cindex active region
10080 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10082 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10083 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10084 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10085 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10086 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10087 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10088 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10089 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10090 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10091 property, that name will be used for the export.
10092 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10093 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10094 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10095 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10096 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10097 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10098 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10099 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10100 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10101 Export only the visible part of the document.
10102 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10103 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10104 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10106 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10107 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10111 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10112 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10113 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10114 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10115 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10118 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10122 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10125 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10126 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10127 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10128 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10129 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10130 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10131 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10132 @vindex org-export-author-info
10133 @vindex org-export-email-info
10134 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10135 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10137 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10139 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10140 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10141 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10143 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10144 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10145 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10146 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10147 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10148 insert any preamble.
10150 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10151 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10152 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10153 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10154 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10155 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10156 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10157 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10158 insert any postamble.
10160 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10161 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10163 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
10164 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10165 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10166 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10167 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10168 the exported file use either
10171 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10173 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10177 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10181 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10186 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10187 @subsection Links in HTML export
10189 @cindex links, in HTML export
10190 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10191 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10192 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
10193 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10194 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10195 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10196 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10197 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10198 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10199 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10200 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10202 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10203 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10204 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10205 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10207 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10209 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10210 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10213 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10215 @cindex tables, in HTML
10216 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10218 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10219 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10220 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10221 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10224 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10226 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10227 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10230 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10231 @subsection Images in HTML export
10233 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10234 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10235 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10236 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10237 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10238 default@footnote{But see the variable
10239 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10240 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10241 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10242 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10243 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10244 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10245 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10246 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10249 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10252 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10253 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10254 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10257 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10259 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10260 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10265 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10267 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10268 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10272 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10273 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10274 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10275 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10276 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10277 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10278 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10279 found on the MathJax website, see
10280 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10281 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10282 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10283 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10286 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10289 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10290 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10293 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10294 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10295 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10296 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10297 You can still get this processing with
10300 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10303 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10304 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10306 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10307 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10308 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10309 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10310 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10311 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10312 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10313 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10314 respectively. For example
10317 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10318 (defun org-xor (a b)
10325 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10326 @subsection CSS support
10327 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10328 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10330 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10331 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10332 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10333 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10334 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10335 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10336 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10337 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10338 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10340 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10341 p.date @r{publishing date}
10342 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10343 .title @r{document title}
10344 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10345 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10346 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10347 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10348 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10349 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10350 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10351 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10352 .target @r{target for links}
10353 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10354 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10355 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10356 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10357 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10358 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10359 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10360 pre.example @r{normal example}
10361 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10362 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10363 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10364 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10365 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10368 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10369 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10370 @vindex org-export-html-style
10371 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10372 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10373 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10374 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10375 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10376 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10377 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10378 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10379 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10380 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10381 individually for each file, you can use
10385 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10389 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10390 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10391 referring to an external file.
10393 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10394 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10395 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10398 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10399 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10401 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10402 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10404 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10405 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10406 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10407 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10408 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10409 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10410 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10411 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10412 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10413 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10414 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10415 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10416 copy on your own web server.
10418 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10419 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10420 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10421 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10422 adding a single line to the Org file:
10424 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10426 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10430 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10431 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10435 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10436 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10437 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10438 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10439 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10440 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10441 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10442 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10443 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10444 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10445 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10446 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10447 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10448 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10449 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10450 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10451 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10452 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10453 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10454 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10455 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10456 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10457 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10458 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10459 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10462 @vindex org-infojs-options
10463 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10464 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10465 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10466 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10468 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10469 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10470 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10472 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10474 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10475 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10476 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10477 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10478 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10479 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10480 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10481 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10482 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10483 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10487 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10488 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10489 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10490 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10491 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10492 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10495 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10496 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10498 @cindex region, active
10499 @cindex active region
10500 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10502 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10503 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10504 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10505 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10506 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10507 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10508 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10509 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10510 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10511 property, that name will be used for the export.
10512 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10513 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10514 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10515 Export only the visible part of the document.
10516 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10517 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10518 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10520 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10521 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10523 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10524 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10525 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10526 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10529 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10530 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10531 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10532 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10533 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10534 convert them to a custom string depending on
10535 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10537 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10538 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10541 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10545 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10547 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10548 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10549 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10550 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10551 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10552 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10553 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10555 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10557 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10558 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10559 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10560 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10561 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10562 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10563 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10564 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10565 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10566 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10567 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10568 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10569 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10570 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10571 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10572 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10573 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10574 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10575 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10576 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10577 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10578 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10579 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10580 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10584 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10585 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10586 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10592 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10593 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10595 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10596 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10597 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10598 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10599 the following constructs:
10602 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10604 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10608 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10612 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10617 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10618 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10619 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10621 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10622 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10623 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10624 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10625 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10626 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10627 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10632 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10634 #+CAPTION: A long table
10636 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10641 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10645 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10647 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10649 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10654 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10655 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10656 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10657 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10659 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10660 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10661 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10662 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10663 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10664 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10665 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10666 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10667 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10668 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10669 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10670 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10671 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10672 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10673 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10674 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10676 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10677 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10678 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10679 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10680 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10681 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10685 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10687 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10688 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10689 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10690 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10692 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10696 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10697 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10698 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10700 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10701 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10703 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10704 @subsection Beamer class export
10706 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10707 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10708 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10710 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10711 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10712 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10713 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10714 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10715 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10716 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10717 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10718 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10719 structure of the presentation.
10721 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10722 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10723 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10724 editing special properties used by beamer.
10726 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10731 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10732 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10733 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10734 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10735 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10736 @item BEAMER_envargs
10737 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10738 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10739 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10740 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10741 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10744 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10745 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10746 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10747 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10748 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10749 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10750 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10751 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10753 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10754 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10758 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10759 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10760 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10761 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10762 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10763 in the presentation as well.
10765 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10766 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10767 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10768 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10769 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10770 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10771 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10773 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10781 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10782 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10783 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10786 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10787 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10788 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10789 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10791 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10794 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10795 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10796 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10797 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10798 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10799 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10800 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10802 * This is the first structural section
10804 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10805 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10808 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10811 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10812 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10816 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10818 for contributing to the discussion
10819 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10820 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10821 *** Request :B_block:
10822 Please test this stuff!
10828 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10830 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10831 @section DocBook export
10832 @cindex DocBook export
10834 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10836 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10837 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10838 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10839 tools and stylesheets.
10841 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10844 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10845 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10846 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10847 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10848 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10849 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10852 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10853 @subsection DocBook export commands
10855 @cindex region, active
10856 @cindex active region
10857 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10859 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10860 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10861 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10862 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10863 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10864 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10865 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10866 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10867 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10868 property, that name will be used for the export.
10869 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10870 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10872 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10873 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10874 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10875 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10876 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10877 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10879 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10880 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10881 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10882 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10883 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10884 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10886 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10887 Export only the visible part of the document.
10890 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10891 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10893 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10894 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10897 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10899 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10903 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10907 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10912 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10913 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10914 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10915 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10920 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10921 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10922 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10927 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10928 @subsection Recursive sections
10929 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10931 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10932 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e.@: @code{section} elements, are
10933 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10934 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10935 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10936 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10938 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10939 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10941 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10942 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10943 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10945 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10948 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10949 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10950 using the @code{table} element.
10952 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10953 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10954 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10955 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10957 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10958 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10959 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10960 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10961 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10962 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10963 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10964 @code{mediaobject} element.
10966 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10967 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10968 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10969 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10970 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10971 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10972 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10973 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10975 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10976 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10977 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10978 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10979 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10984 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10986 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10987 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10988 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10989 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10992 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10993 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10994 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10995 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10996 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10998 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10999 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
11000 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
11002 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
11003 @vindex org-entities
11004 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
11005 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
11006 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
11007 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
11008 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
11009 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
11011 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
11012 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
11013 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
11014 special characters included in XHTML entities:
11017 "<!DOCTYPE article [
11018 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11019 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11020 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11027 @c begin opendocument
11029 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11030 @section OpenDocument Text export
11031 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11033 @cindex OpenDocument
11034 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11035 @cindex LibreOffice
11037 @cindex org-modules
11039 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11040 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11041 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11042 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11043 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11044 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11047 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11048 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11049 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11050 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11051 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11052 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11053 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11054 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11055 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11056 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11057 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11060 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11061 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11063 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11064 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11066 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11067 @subsection ODT export commands
11069 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11070 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11072 @cindex region, active
11073 @cindex active region
11074 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11076 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11077 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11079 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11081 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11082 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11083 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11084 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11086 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11087 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11088 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11089 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11090 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11091 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11092 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11095 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11096 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11098 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11099 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11100 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11101 exporting to other formats}.
11104 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11105 @subsection Extending ODT export
11107 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11108 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11109 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11110 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11112 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11113 @cindex LibreOffice
11114 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11115 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11116 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11117 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11118 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11119 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11120 document converter}.
11122 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11123 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11125 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11126 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11127 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11128 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11129 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11130 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11131 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11132 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11134 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11135 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11137 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11138 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11139 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11140 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11141 the following command.
11143 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11146 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11147 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11148 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11151 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11152 @subsection Applying custom styles
11153 @cindex styles, custom
11154 @cindex template, custom
11156 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11157 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11158 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11159 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11160 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11161 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11162 users alike, and is described here.
11164 @subsubsection Applying custom styles - the easy way
11168 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11172 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11176 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11177 to locate the target styles - these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix -
11178 and modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11179 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11182 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11183 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11184 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11185 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11186 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11188 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11189 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11192 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11198 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11203 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11205 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11206 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11207 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11208 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11209 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11210 the factory settings.
11212 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11213 @subsection Links in ODT export
11214 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11216 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11217 Internet-style links for all other links.
11219 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11220 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11222 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11223 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11224 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11226 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11227 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11228 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11230 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11231 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables -
11232 tables that have column or row spans - is not supported. Such tables are
11233 stripped from the exported document.
11235 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11236 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11237 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11238 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11239 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11240 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11243 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11244 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11246 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11250 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11251 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11252 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11254 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11255 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11256 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11257 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11258 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11259 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11262 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11263 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11264 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11265 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11266 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11268 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11269 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11270 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11272 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11273 @subsection Images in ODT export
11274 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11275 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11277 @subsubheading Embedding images
11278 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11279 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11280 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11290 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11291 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11292 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11293 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11294 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11297 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11300 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11303 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11304 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11306 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11307 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11308 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11309 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11310 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11311 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11312 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11313 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11314 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11315 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11316 converted in to units of centimeters using
11317 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11318 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11319 achieve the best results.
11321 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11324 @item Explicitly size the image
11325 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11328 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11332 @item Scale the image
11333 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11336 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11340 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11341 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11342 height:width ratio, do the following:
11345 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11349 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11350 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11351 height:width ratio, do the following
11354 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11359 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11362 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11363 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11364 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property -
11365 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11367 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11369 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11373 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11374 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11376 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11379 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11380 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11383 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11384 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11386 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11387 document in one of the following ways:
11393 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11399 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11400 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11401 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11402 the exported document.
11404 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11405 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11407 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11408 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11409 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11411 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11412 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11413 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11416 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11417 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11418 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11419 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11422 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11423 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11427 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11428 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11430 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11431 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11432 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11438 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11441 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11444 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11445 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11446 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11449 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11450 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11452 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11453 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11454 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11455 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11467 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11468 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11470 You can label and caption various category of objects - an inline image, a
11471 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula - using @code{#+LABEL} and
11472 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11473 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11474 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11475 appearance in the Org file.
11477 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11478 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11482 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11483 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11487 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11490 Figure 2: Bell curve
11493 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11494 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11495 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11496 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11497 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11500 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11501 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11504 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11508 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11511 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11512 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11514 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11515 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11516 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11517 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11518 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11519 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11520 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11522 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11523 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11524 by customizing the variable
11525 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11527 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11528 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11529 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11531 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11532 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11534 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11535 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11536 that would be of interest to power users.
11539 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11540 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11541 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11542 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11543 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11546 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11547 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11549 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11552 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11553 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11554 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11555 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11558 @item Register the converter
11560 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11561 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11562 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11563 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11565 @item Configure its capabilities
11567 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11568 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11569 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11570 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11571 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11572 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11573 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11574 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11576 @item Choose the converter
11578 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11579 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11580 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11583 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11584 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11585 @cindex styles, custom
11586 @cindex template, custom
11588 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11589 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11590 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11593 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11594 @subsubheading Factory styles
11596 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11597 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11598 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11601 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11603 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11605 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11606 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11610 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11613 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11617 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11619 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11621 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11622 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11623 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11625 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11626 file serves the following purposes:
11630 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11634 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11635 elements that control how various entities - tables, images, equations etc -
11640 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11641 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11642 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11643 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11644 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11648 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11650 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11652 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11653 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11656 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11658 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11660 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11662 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11665 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11667 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11668 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11669 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11671 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11672 like header and footer images.
11676 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11679 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11681 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11683 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11684 in the final output.
11687 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11688 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11690 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11691 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11692 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11695 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11697 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11698 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11701 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11702 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11706 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11707 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11708 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11711 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11712 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11716 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11718 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11719 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11722 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11725 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11726 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11727 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11730 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11731 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11732 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11736 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11738 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11739 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11741 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11746 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11747 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11754 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11755 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11756 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11759 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11760 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11761 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11763 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11765 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11766 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11770 @subsubheading Custom table styles - an illustration
11772 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11773 the table that follows.
11776 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11777 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11778 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11779 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11780 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11781 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11782 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11783 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11787 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11788 | Name | Phone | Age |
11789 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11790 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11793 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11794 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11795 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11796 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11797 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11798 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11799 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11800 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11802 @subsubheading Custom table styles - the nitty-gritty
11803 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11807 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11808 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11810 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11811 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11825 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11826 template using a well-defined convention.
11828 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11829 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11830 the following table.
11832 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11833 @headitem Table cell type
11834 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11835 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11840 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11841 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11843 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11844 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11846 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11847 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11849 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11850 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11852 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11853 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11855 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11856 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11858 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11859 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11861 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11862 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11864 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11865 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11868 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11870 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11871 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11875 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11876 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11877 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11878 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11879 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11880 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11882 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11883 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11884 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11887 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11888 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11891 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11892 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11893 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11894 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11897 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11898 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11899 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11900 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11901 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11902 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11903 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11904 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11908 Associate a table with the table style
11910 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11911 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11914 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11915 | Name | Phone | Age |
11916 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11917 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11921 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11922 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11924 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11925 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11926 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11927 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11928 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11930 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11931 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11932 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11933 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11935 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11936 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11937 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11938 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11939 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11940 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11942 @c end opendocument
11944 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11945 @section TaskJuggler export
11946 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11947 @cindex Project management
11949 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11950 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11951 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11954 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11955 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11956 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11959 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11960 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11961 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11964 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11967 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11968 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11970 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11971 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11976 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11977 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11978 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11979 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11980 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11981 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11982 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11983 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11984 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11985 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11987 @subsection Resources
11989 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11990 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11991 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11992 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11993 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11994 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11995 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11996 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11997 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11998 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11999 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
12000 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
12001 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
12003 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
12004 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
12007 @subsection Export of properties
12009 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.@: if a
12010 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
12011 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
12012 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
12013 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
12014 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
12015 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
12016 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
12017 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
12019 @subsection Dependencies
12021 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12022 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12023 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12024 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12025 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12026 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12027 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12028 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12029 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12030 examples should illustrate this:
12035 :task_id: preparation
12038 * Training material
12040 :task_id: training_material
12043 ** Markup Guidelines
12047 ** Workflow Guidelines
12054 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12058 @subsection Reports
12060 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12061 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g.@: gantt chart, resource
12062 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12063 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12064 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12065 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12066 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12067 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12069 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12070 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12072 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12073 @section Freemind export
12074 @cindex Freemind export
12077 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12080 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12081 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12082 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12085 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12086 @section XOXO export
12087 @cindex XOXO export
12089 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12090 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12091 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12094 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12095 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12096 @file{myfile.html}.
12097 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12098 Export only the visible part of the document.
12101 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12102 @section iCalendar export
12103 @cindex iCalendar export
12105 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12106 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12107 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12108 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12109 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12110 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12111 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12112 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12113 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12114 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12115 included in the export, configure the variable
12116 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12117 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12118 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12119 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12120 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12121 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12122 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12123 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12124 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12127 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12128 @cindex property, ID
12129 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12130 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12131 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12132 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12133 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12134 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12135 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12136 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12137 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12140 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12141 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12142 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12143 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12144 @vindex org-agenda-files
12145 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12146 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12147 file will be written.
12148 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12149 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12150 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12151 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12152 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12155 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12156 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12157 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12158 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12159 @cindex property, LOCATION
12160 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12161 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12162 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12163 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12164 and the description from the body (limited to
12165 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12167 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12168 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12170 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12171 @chapter Publishing
12174 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12175 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12176 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12177 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12180 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12181 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12183 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12186 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12187 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12188 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12189 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12192 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12193 @section Configuration
12195 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12196 and many other properties of a project.
12199 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12200 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12201 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12202 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12203 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12204 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12205 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12206 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12209 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12210 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12211 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12212 @cindex projects, for publishing
12214 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12215 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12216 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12217 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12220 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12221 @r{i.e.@: a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12223 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12227 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12228 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12229 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12230 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12231 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12232 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12233 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12236 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12237 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12238 @cindex directories, for publishing
12240 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12241 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12242 and where to put published files.
12244 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12245 @item @code{:base-directory}
12246 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12247 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12248 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12249 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12250 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12251 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12252 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12253 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12254 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12255 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12256 variable @code{project-plist}.
12257 @item @code{:completion-function}
12258 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12259 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12260 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12261 @code{project-plist}.
12265 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12266 @subsection Selecting files
12267 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12269 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12270 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12272 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12273 @item @code{:base-extension}
12274 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12275 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12276 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12278 @item @code{:exclude}
12279 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12280 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12283 @item @code{:include}
12284 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12285 and @code{:exclude}.
12287 @item @code{:recursive}
12288 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12291 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12292 @subsection Publishing action
12293 @cindex action, for publishing
12295 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12296 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12297 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12298 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12299 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12300 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12301 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12302 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12303 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12304 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12305 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12306 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12307 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12308 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12309 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12310 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12311 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12312 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12313 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12315 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12316 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12317 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12318 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12319 @item @code{:plain-source}
12320 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12321 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12322 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12325 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12326 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12327 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12328 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12329 and place the result into the destination folder.
12331 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12332 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12333 @cindex options, for publishing
12335 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12336 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12337 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12338 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12339 respective variable for details.
12341 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12342 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12343 @vindex org-export-default-language
12344 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12345 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12346 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12347 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12348 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12349 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12350 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12351 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12352 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12353 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12354 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12355 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12356 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12357 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12358 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12359 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12360 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12361 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12362 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12363 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12364 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12365 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12366 @vindex org-export-author-info
12367 @vindex org-export-email-info
12368 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12369 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12370 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12371 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12372 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12373 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12374 @vindex org-export-html-style
12375 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12376 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12377 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12378 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12379 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12380 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12381 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12382 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12383 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12384 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12385 @vindex user-full-name
12386 @vindex user-mail-address
12387 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12388 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12390 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12391 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12392 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12393 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12394 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12395 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12396 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12397 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12398 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12399 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12400 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12401 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12402 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12403 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12404 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12405 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12406 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12407 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12408 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12409 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12410 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12411 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12412 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12413 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12414 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12415 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12416 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12417 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12418 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12419 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12420 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12421 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12422 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12423 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12424 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12425 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12426 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12427 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12428 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12429 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12430 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12431 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12432 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12433 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12434 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12435 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12436 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12437 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12438 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12439 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12442 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12443 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12444 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12445 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12450 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12451 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12452 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12453 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12454 options}), however, override everything.
12456 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12457 @subsection Links between published files
12458 @cindex links, publishing
12460 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12461 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12462 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12463 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12464 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12465 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12466 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12467 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12470 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12471 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12472 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12473 an example of this usage.
12475 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12476 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12477 location. In this case, use the property
12479 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12480 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12481 @tab Function to validate links
12485 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12486 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12487 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12488 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12489 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12490 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12491 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12493 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12494 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12495 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12497 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12498 a map of files for a given project.
12500 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12501 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12502 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12503 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12505 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12506 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12507 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12509 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12510 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12512 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12513 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12514 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12515 of links to all files in the project.
12517 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12518 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12519 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12520 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12522 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12523 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12524 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12525 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12526 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12527 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12528 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12530 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12531 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12533 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12534 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12535 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12536 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12537 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12538 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12539 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12541 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12542 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12543 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12544 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12546 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12547 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12548 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12549 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12553 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12554 @subsection Generating an index
12555 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12557 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12559 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12560 @item @code{:makeindex}
12561 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12562 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12565 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12566 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12567 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12568 a title, style information, etc.
12570 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12571 @section Uploading files
12575 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12576 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12577 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12578 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12579 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12582 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12583 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12584 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12585 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12586 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12588 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12589 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12590 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12591 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12592 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12593 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12596 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12597 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12598 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12599 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12600 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12601 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12603 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12604 @section Sample configuration
12606 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12607 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12608 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12611 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12612 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12615 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12616 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12618 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12619 directory on the local machine.
12622 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12624 :base-directory "~/org/"
12625 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12626 :section-numbers nil
12627 :table-of-contents nil
12628 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12629 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12630 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12633 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12634 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12636 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12637 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12638 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12641 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12642 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12643 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12644 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12647 file:../images/myimage.png
12650 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12651 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12652 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12655 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12657 :base-directory "~/org/"
12658 :base-extension "org"
12659 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12660 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12661 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12663 :section-numbers nil
12664 :table-of-contents nil
12665 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12666 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12670 :base-directory "~/images/"
12671 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12672 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12673 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12676 :base-directory "~/other/"
12677 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12678 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12679 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12680 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12683 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12684 @section Triggering publication
12686 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12689 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12690 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12691 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12692 Publish the project containing the current file.
12693 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12694 Publish only the current file.
12695 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12696 Publish every project.
12699 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12700 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12701 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12702 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12703 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12704 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12705 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12707 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12708 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12710 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12711 @chapter Working with source code
12712 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12713 @cindex Davison, Dan
12714 @cindex source code, working with
12716 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12720 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12721 (defun org-xor (a b)
12727 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12728 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12729 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12730 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12731 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12732 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12734 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12737 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12738 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12739 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12740 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12741 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12742 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12743 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12744 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12745 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12746 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12747 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12748 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12751 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12752 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12754 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12755 @section Structure of code blocks
12756 @cindex code block, structure
12757 @cindex source code, block structure
12759 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12761 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12762 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12763 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12767 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12772 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12773 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12774 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12775 @cindex source code, inline
12777 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12780 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12786 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12790 @item <#+NAME: name>
12791 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12792 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12793 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12794 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12795 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12796 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12800 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12801 @cindex source code, language
12803 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12804 @ref{Literal examples})
12805 @cindex source code, switches
12806 @item <header arguments>
12807 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12808 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12809 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12810 basis using properties.
12811 @item source code, header arguments
12813 Source code in the specified language.
12816 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12817 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12819 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12820 @section Editing source code
12821 @cindex code block, editing
12822 @cindex source code, editing
12825 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12826 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12827 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12828 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12830 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12831 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12832 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12833 further configuration options.
12836 @item org-src-lang-modes
12837 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12838 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12839 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12840 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12841 @item org-src-window-setup
12842 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12843 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12844 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12845 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12846 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12847 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12848 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12851 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12852 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12854 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12855 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12857 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12858 @section Exporting code blocks
12859 @cindex code block, exporting
12860 @cindex source code, exporting
12862 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12863 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12864 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12865 However, for some languages (e.g.@: @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12866 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12867 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12869 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12872 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12874 @item :exports code
12875 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12876 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12877 @item :exports results
12878 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12879 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12880 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12881 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12882 block will not be exported.
12883 @item :exports both
12884 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12885 @item :exports none
12886 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12889 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12890 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12891 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12892 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12893 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12894 markup language for a wiki.
12896 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12897 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12898 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12899 @section Extracting source code
12901 @cindex source code, extracting
12902 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12904 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12905 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12906 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12907 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12908 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12910 @subsubheading Header arguments
12913 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12915 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12916 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12917 for the block language.
12918 @item :tangle filename
12919 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12923 @subsubheading Functions
12925 @item org-babel-tangle
12926 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12927 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12928 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12931 @subsubheading Hooks
12933 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12934 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12935 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12936 of tangled code files.
12939 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12940 @section Evaluating code blocks
12941 @cindex code block, evaluating
12942 @cindex source code, evaluating
12945 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12946 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12947 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12948 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12949 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12950 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12951 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12952 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12953 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12954 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12956 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12957 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12958 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12959 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12960 used to define a code block).
12963 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12964 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12965 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12966 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12967 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12968 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12971 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12972 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12973 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12974 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12975 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12977 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12980 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12981 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12984 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12987 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12988 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12993 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12995 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12996 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12997 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12998 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12999 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
13000 @item <inside header arguments>
13001 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
13002 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
13003 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
13004 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
13005 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
13006 @item <end header arguments>
13007 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
13008 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
13009 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
13010 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
13011 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
13013 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
13014 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
13017 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
13018 @section Library of Babel
13019 @cindex babel, library of
13020 @cindex source code, library
13021 @cindex code block, library
13023 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13024 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13025 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13026 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13029 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13030 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13032 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13033 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13034 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13038 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13039 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13042 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13044 @cindex babel, languages
13045 @cindex source code, languages
13046 @cindex code block, languages
13048 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13050 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13051 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13052 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13053 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13054 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13055 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13056 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13057 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13058 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13059 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13060 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13061 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13062 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13063 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13064 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13065 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13066 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13067 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13068 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13069 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13072 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13073 available, it can be found at
13074 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13076 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13077 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13078 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13079 to your emacs configuration.
13082 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13083 @code{R} code blocks.
13087 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13088 'org-babel-load-languages
13089 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13093 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13094 elisp file with @code{require}.
13097 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13101 (require 'ob-clojure)
13104 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13105 @section Header arguments
13106 @cindex code block, header arguments
13107 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13109 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13110 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13111 describes each header argument in detail.
13114 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13115 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13118 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13119 @subsection Using header arguments
13121 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13122 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13124 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13125 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13126 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13127 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13128 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13129 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13133 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13134 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13135 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13136 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13137 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13141 :results => "replace"
13148 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13150 @c ((:session . "none")
13151 @c (:results . "replace")
13152 @c (:exports . "code")
13154 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13158 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13161 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13162 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13163 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13167 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13168 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13169 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13172 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13173 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13174 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13175 language-specific documentation available online at
13176 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13178 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13179 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13180 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13181 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13182 @ref{Property syntax}).
13184 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13185 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13186 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13187 inserted into the buffer.
13190 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13191 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13194 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13195 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13197 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13198 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13199 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13202 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13205 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13206 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13207 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13208 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13209 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13210 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13220 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13221 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13222 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13223 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13224 in Org mode documents.
13226 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13227 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13229 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13230 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13231 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13232 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13233 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13234 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13235 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13236 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13237 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13238 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13242 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13244 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13247 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13250 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13253 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13254 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13255 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13259 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13261 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13262 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13263 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13270 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13272 #+NAME: named-block
13273 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13274 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13275 (message "data:%S" data)
13278 #+RESULTS: named-block
13282 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13283 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13284 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13286 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13287 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13288 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13291 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13292 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13294 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13297 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13298 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13300 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13303 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13304 @subsection Specific header arguments
13305 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13306 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13309 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13310 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13311 be collected and handled
13312 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13313 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13314 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13315 directory for code block execution
13316 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13317 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13318 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13319 files during tangling
13320 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13322 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13324 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13325 expansion during tangling
13326 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13327 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13328 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13329 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13330 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13331 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13332 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13333 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13334 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13335 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13336 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13337 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13340 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13343 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13344 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13345 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13346 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13347 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13348 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13349 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13351 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13352 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13353 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13354 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13355 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13358 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13359 Indexable variable values}).
13361 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13362 @code{:var} header argument.
13368 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13369 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13370 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13371 results of evaluating another code block.
13373 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13378 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13380 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13386 #+NAME: table-length
13387 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13391 #+RESULTS: table-length
13396 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13397 carried through to the source code block)
13400 #+NAME: example-list
13406 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13414 @item code block without arguments
13415 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13416 optionally followed by parentheses
13419 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13427 @item code block with arguments
13428 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13429 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13430 code block name using standard function call syntax
13434 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13442 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13450 @item literal example
13451 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13454 #+NAME: literal-example
13460 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13461 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13462 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13465 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13466 : A literal example
13467 : on two lines for you.
13473 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13474 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13475 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13476 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13477 following the source name.
13480 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13481 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13486 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13487 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13488 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13489 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13490 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13491 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13492 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13493 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13494 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13497 #+NAME: example-table
13503 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13511 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13512 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13513 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13517 #+NAME: example-table
13524 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13534 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13535 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13536 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13537 column is referenced.
13540 #+NAME: example-table
13546 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13554 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13555 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13556 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13560 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13561 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13562 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13563 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13566 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13574 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13576 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13577 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13578 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13579 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13580 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13581 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13582 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13583 evaluation of the code block body.
13586 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13591 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13592 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13598 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13607 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13608 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13610 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13611 per class may be supplied per code block.
13615 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13616 from the code block
13618 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13619 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13622 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13623 block should be handled.
13626 @subsubheading Collection
13627 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13628 should be collected from the code block.
13632 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13633 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13634 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13635 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13636 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13637 @item @code{output}
13638 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13639 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13640 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13643 @subsubheading Type
13645 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13646 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13647 table or scalar depending on their value.
13650 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13651 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13652 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13653 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13655 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13656 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13657 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13658 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13659 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13660 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13662 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13663 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13664 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
13665 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13666 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13667 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13669 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13670 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13672 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13673 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13675 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13676 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13678 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13679 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13680 @code{:results value pp}.
13682 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13683 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13684 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13687 @subsubheading Handling
13688 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13689 results once they are collected.
13692 @item @code{silent}
13693 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13694 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13695 @item @code{replace}
13696 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13697 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13698 @code{:results output replace}.
13699 @item @code{append}
13700 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13701 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13702 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13703 @item @code{prepend}
13704 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13705 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13706 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13709 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13710 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13712 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13713 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13714 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13715 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13716 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13717 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13718 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13719 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13721 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13722 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13723 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13725 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13726 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13728 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13729 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13730 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13731 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13732 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13734 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13735 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13737 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13738 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13739 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13740 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13741 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13742 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13743 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13745 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13746 (e.g.@: @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13747 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13749 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13750 in your home directory, you could use
13753 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13754 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13758 @subsubheading Remote execution
13759 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13760 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13763 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13764 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13768 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13769 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13770 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13773 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13774 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13777 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13780 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13781 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13782 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13783 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13785 @subsubheading Further points
13789 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13790 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13791 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13793 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13794 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13795 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13796 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13797 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13798 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13799 which the link does not point.
13802 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13803 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13805 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13806 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13810 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13811 @code{:exports code}.
13812 @item @code{results}
13813 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13814 @code{:exports results}.
13816 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13817 @code{:exports both}.
13819 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13822 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13823 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13825 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13826 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13829 @item @code{tangle}
13830 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13831 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13832 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13834 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13835 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13837 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13838 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13839 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13842 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13843 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13845 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13846 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13847 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13849 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13850 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13851 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13852 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13853 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13854 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13858 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13860 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13861 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13863 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13865 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13867 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13868 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13870 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13872 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13873 references in the code block body in link comments.
13876 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13877 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13878 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13879 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13880 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13885 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13887 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13890 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13891 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13893 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13894 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13895 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13896 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13897 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13899 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13900 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13902 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13903 language where state is preserved.
13905 By default, a session is not started.
13907 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13908 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13909 interpreted language.
13911 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13912 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13914 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13915 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13916 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13917 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13918 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13922 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13923 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13925 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13926 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13927 @item @code{tangle}
13928 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13929 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13930 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13931 @item @code{no-export}
13932 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13933 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13934 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13935 @item @code{strip-export}
13936 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13937 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13938 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13940 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13941 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13944 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13945 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13946 @code{<<reference>>}.
13947 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13948 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13949 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13962 -- multi-line body of example
13965 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13966 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13969 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13970 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13971 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13972 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13973 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13974 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13976 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13977 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13978 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13979 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13980 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13984 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13987 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13989 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13992 ** query all mounted disks
13997 ** strip the header row
14002 ** sort by the percent full
14004 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
14007 ** extract the mount point
14009 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14013 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14014 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14017 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14018 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14020 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14021 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14024 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14025 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14027 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14028 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14029 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14030 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14031 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14032 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14033 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14037 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14038 every time it is called.
14040 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14041 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14042 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14043 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14044 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14047 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14048 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14049 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14050 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14051 changed since it was last run.
14055 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14059 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14063 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14067 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14071 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14072 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14074 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14075 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14076 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14077 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14078 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14081 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14084 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14085 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14087 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14088 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14089 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14093 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14094 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14095 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14096 default value yields the following results.
14099 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14107 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14111 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14118 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14121 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14129 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14133 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14142 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14143 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14145 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14146 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14147 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14148 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14149 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14150 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14154 If an input table looks like it has column names
14155 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14156 names will be removed from the table before
14157 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14160 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14166 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14167 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14168 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14171 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14178 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14179 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14182 No column name pre-processing takes place
14185 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14186 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e.@: the second row is not an
14190 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14191 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14193 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14194 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14198 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14201 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14202 and is then reapplied to the results.
14205 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14206 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14207 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14209 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14210 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14211 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14214 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14215 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14216 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14219 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14220 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14224 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14225 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14227 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14228 (e.g.@: @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14229 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14230 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14232 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14233 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14234 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14235 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14236 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14237 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14238 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14239 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14243 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14245 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14246 @item never-export or no-export
14247 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14250 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14253 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14254 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14257 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14258 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14259 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14260 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14261 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14262 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14263 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14265 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14266 @section Results of evaluation
14267 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14268 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14270 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14271 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14272 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14273 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14275 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14276 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14277 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14278 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14281 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14282 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14283 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14285 @subsection Non-session
14286 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14287 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14288 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14289 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14290 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14291 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14292 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14294 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14295 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14297 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14298 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14299 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14300 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14303 @subsection Session
14304 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14305 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14306 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14307 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14308 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14309 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14310 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14311 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14313 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14314 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14315 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14316 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14319 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14320 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14321 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14322 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14323 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14324 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14325 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14328 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14339 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14341 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14353 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14354 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14357 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14358 @section Noweb reference syntax
14359 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14360 @cindex syntax, noweb
14361 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14363 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14364 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14365 familiar Noweb syntax:
14368 <<code-block-name>>
14371 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14372 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14373 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14374 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14375 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14376 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14378 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14379 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14380 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14383 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14386 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14387 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14388 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14389 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14392 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14393 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14394 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14395 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14398 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14399 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14400 @cindex code block, key bindings
14402 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14405 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14408 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14410 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14412 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14414 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14416 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14419 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14421 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14423 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14424 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14426 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14427 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14429 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14430 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14432 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14433 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14435 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14436 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14438 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14439 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14441 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14442 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14444 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14445 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14447 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14448 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14450 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14451 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14453 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14454 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14456 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14457 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14459 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14460 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14462 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14463 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14465 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14466 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14468 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14469 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14471 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14472 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14474 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14475 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14477 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14478 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14480 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14481 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14483 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14484 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14486 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14487 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14490 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14491 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14493 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14494 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14495 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14496 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14497 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14498 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14499 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14500 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14501 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14504 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14505 @section Batch execution
14506 @cindex code block, batch execution
14507 @cindex source code, batch execution
14509 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14510 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14512 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14516 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14518 # tangle files with org-mode
14522 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
14524 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14526 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14529 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
14531 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14532 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
14533 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14534 (mapc (lambda (file)
14535 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14537 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14540 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14541 @chapter Miscellaneous
14544 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14545 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14546 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14547 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14548 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14549 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14550 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14551 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14552 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14553 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14554 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14558 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14559 @section Completion
14560 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14561 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14562 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14563 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14564 @cindex completion, of tags
14565 @cindex completion, of property keys
14566 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14567 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14568 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14569 @cindex dictionary word completion
14570 @cindex option keyword completion
14571 @cindex tag completion
14572 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14574 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14575 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14576 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14577 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14578 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14580 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14581 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14582 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14585 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14587 Complete word at point
14590 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14592 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14594 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14595 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14597 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14598 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14599 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14600 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14602 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14603 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14606 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14608 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14609 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14610 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14611 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14613 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14614 i.e.@: valid keys for this line.
14616 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14620 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14621 @section Easy Templates
14622 @cindex template insertion
14623 @cindex insertion, of templates
14625 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14626 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14627 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14628 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14629 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14631 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14632 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14633 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14635 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14637 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14638 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14639 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14640 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14641 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14642 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14643 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14644 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14645 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14646 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14647 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14648 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14649 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14650 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14653 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14654 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14656 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14657 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14658 additional details.
14660 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14661 @section Speed keys
14663 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14664 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14666 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14667 beginning of a headline, i.e.@: before the first star. Configure the variable
14668 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14669 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14670 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14671 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14672 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14673 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14675 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14676 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14678 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14679 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14681 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14683 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14684 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14685 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14686 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14687 these precautions intact.
14689 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14690 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14691 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14693 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14696 @item Source code blocks
14697 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14698 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14699 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14700 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14701 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14703 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14704 which take off the default security brakes.
14706 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14707 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14708 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14709 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14710 ask and nil not to ask.
14713 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14716 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14717 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14718 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14721 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14722 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14723 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14726 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14727 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14729 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14730 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14733 @item Formulas in tables
14734 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14735 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14738 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14739 @section Customization
14740 @cindex customization
14741 @cindex options, for customization
14742 @cindex variables, for customization
14744 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14745 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14746 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14747 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14748 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14749 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14750 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14752 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14753 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14754 @cindex in-buffer settings
14755 @cindex special keywords
14757 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14758 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14759 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14760 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14761 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14762 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14763 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14764 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14765 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14767 @vindex org-archive-location
14769 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14770 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14771 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14772 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14773 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14775 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14776 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14777 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14778 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14779 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14780 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14781 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14783 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14784 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14785 @vindex org-table-formula
14786 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14787 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14788 The global version of this variable is
14789 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14790 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14791 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14793 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14794 @vindex org-drawers
14795 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14796 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14797 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14798 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14799 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14800 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14801 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14802 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14803 @vindex org-highest-priority
14804 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14805 @vindex org-default-priority
14806 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14807 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
14808 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14809 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14810 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14811 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14812 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14813 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14814 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14815 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14816 (i.e.@: when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14817 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14818 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14819 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14820 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14823 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14824 Org file is being visited.
14826 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14827 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14828 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14830 @vindex org-startup-folded
14831 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14832 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14833 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14834 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14836 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14837 content @r{all headlines}
14838 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14839 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14842 @vindex org-startup-indented
14843 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14844 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14845 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14846 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14848 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14849 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14852 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14853 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14854 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14855 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14857 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14858 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14860 align @r{align all tables}
14861 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14864 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14865 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14866 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14867 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14868 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14869 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14871 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14872 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14875 @vindex org-log-done
14876 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14877 @vindex org-log-repeat
14878 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14879 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14880 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14881 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14882 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14883 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14884 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14885 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14886 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14887 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14888 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14889 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14890 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14891 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14892 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14893 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14894 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14895 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14896 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14897 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14899 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14900 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14901 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14902 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14903 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14904 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14905 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14906 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14907 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14908 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14909 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14910 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14911 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14912 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14913 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14914 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14915 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14917 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14918 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14919 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14920 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14921 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14922 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14923 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14924 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14925 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14926 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14928 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14929 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14930 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14931 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14932 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14933 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14935 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14936 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14937 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14938 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14939 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14940 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14942 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14944 @vindex constants-unit-system
14945 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14946 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14947 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14948 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14950 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14951 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14953 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14954 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14955 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14956 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14957 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14958 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14959 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14960 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14961 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14962 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14963 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14964 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14965 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14966 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14967 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14969 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14970 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14971 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14972 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14973 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14974 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14975 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14976 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14977 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14979 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14980 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14981 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14982 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14983 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14985 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14986 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14988 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14989 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14990 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14991 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14992 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14994 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14995 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14997 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14998 @vindex org-tag-alist
14999 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
15000 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
15001 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
15003 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
15004 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
15005 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
15006 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
15007 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
15008 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
15009 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15010 @ref{Export options}.
15011 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15012 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15013 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15014 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15017 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15018 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15020 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15022 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15023 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15024 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15025 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15026 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15027 what this means in different contexts.
15031 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15032 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15034 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15035 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15038 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15039 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15041 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15044 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15045 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15048 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15049 corresponding links in this buffer.
15051 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15052 drawer, offer property commands.
15054 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15055 definition, and vice versa.
15057 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15059 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15062 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15065 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15068 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15071 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15072 @section A cleaner outline view
15073 @cindex hiding leading stars
15074 @cindex dynamic indentation
15075 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15076 @cindex clean outline view
15078 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15079 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15080 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15081 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15082 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15086 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15087 ** Second level | * Second level
15088 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15089 some text | some text
15090 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15091 more text | more text
15092 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15098 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15099 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15100 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15101 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15102 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15103 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15104 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15105 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15106 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15107 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15108 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15109 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15110 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15111 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15112 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15113 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15114 individual files using
15120 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15121 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15122 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15127 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15128 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15129 with the headline, like
15133 more text, now indented
15136 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15137 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15138 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15139 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15142 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15143 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15144 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15145 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15149 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15150 #+STARTUP: showstars
15153 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15157 * Top level headline
15165 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15166 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15167 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15168 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15169 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15170 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15171 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15174 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15175 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15176 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15177 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15178 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
15179 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15180 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15181 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15182 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15189 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15190 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15191 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15192 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15195 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15196 @section Using Org on a tty
15197 @cindex tty key bindings
15199 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15200 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15201 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15202 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15203 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15204 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15205 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15206 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15207 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15208 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15209 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15211 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15212 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15213 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15214 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15215 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15216 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15217 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15218 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15219 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15220 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15221 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15222 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15223 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15224 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15225 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15226 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15227 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15228 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15229 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15230 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15234 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15235 @section Interaction with other packages
15236 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15237 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15238 with other code out there.
15241 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15242 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15245 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15246 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15249 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15250 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15251 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15252 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15253 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15254 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15255 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15256 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15257 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15258 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15259 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15260 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15261 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15262 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15263 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15264 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15265 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15266 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15267 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15268 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15269 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15270 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15271 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15272 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15273 @file{constants.el}.
15274 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15275 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15276 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15277 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15278 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15279 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15280 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15281 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15282 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15284 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15285 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15287 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15288 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15289 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15290 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15291 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15292 @cindex Wiegley, John
15293 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15294 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15295 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15296 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15297 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15298 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15299 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15300 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15301 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15302 @cindex @file{table.el}
15303 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15305 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15306 @cindex @file{table.el}
15307 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15309 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15310 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15311 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15312 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15313 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15314 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15315 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15318 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15319 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15321 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15322 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15323 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15324 format. See the documentation string of the command
15325 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15328 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15329 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15330 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15331 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15332 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15333 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15334 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15337 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15338 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15342 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15343 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15344 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15345 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15346 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15347 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15348 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15349 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15350 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15351 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15352 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15353 cursor moves across a special context.
15355 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15356 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15357 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15358 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15359 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15360 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15361 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15362 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15363 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15364 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15365 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15366 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15367 buffer (but not during date selection).
15370 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15371 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15372 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15375 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15376 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15377 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15378 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15380 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15381 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15382 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15383 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15384 fixed this problem:
15387 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15389 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15390 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15393 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15394 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15398 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15399 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15402 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15405 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15407 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15408 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15409 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15410 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15413 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15414 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15415 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15416 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15417 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15418 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15422 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15423 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15424 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15425 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15426 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15429 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15430 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15432 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15433 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15434 another key for this command, or override the key in
15435 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15438 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15443 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15444 @section org-crypt.el
15445 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15446 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15448 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15449 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15452 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15453 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15454 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15456 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15460 (require 'org-crypt)
15461 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15462 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15464 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15465 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15466 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15468 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15469 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15470 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15471 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15474 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15476 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15479 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15480 being encrypted again.
15482 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15486 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15490 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15491 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15492 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15493 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15494 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15495 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15496 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15497 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15498 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15499 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15502 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15506 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15507 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15508 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15509 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15510 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15512 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15513 @section Add-on packages
15514 @cindex add-on packages
15516 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15517 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15518 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15519 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15520 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15521 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15525 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15526 @section Adding hyperlink types
15527 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15529 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15530 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15531 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15532 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15533 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15537 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15541 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15542 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15544 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15545 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15547 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15549 (defun org-man-open (path)
15550 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15551 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15552 (funcall org-man-command path))
15554 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15555 "Store a link to a manpage."
15556 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15557 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15558 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15559 (link (concat "man:" page))
15560 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15561 (org-store-link-props
15564 :description description))))
15566 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15567 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15568 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15569 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15570 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15571 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15575 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15579 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15586 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15589 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15592 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15593 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15594 that will be called to follow such a link.
15596 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15597 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15598 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15599 buffer displaying a man page.
15602 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15603 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15604 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15605 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15606 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15607 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15608 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15610 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15611 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15612 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15613 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15614 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15615 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15616 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15617 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15618 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15619 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15620 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15621 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15623 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15624 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
15625 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15626 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15628 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15629 @section Context-sensitive commands
15630 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15631 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15632 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15634 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15635 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15636 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15638 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15639 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15640 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15641 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15642 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15643 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15644 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15648 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15649 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15650 (if (save-excursion
15651 (beginning-of-line 1)
15652 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15653 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15654 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15655 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15657 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15660 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15661 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15662 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15663 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15664 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15667 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15668 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15669 @cindex tables, in other modes
15670 @cindex lists, in other modes
15671 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15673 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15674 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15675 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15676 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15677 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15680 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15681 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15682 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15683 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15684 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15685 for a very flexible system.
15687 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15688 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15689 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15690 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15694 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15695 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15696 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15697 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15700 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15701 @subsection Radio tables
15702 @cindex radio tables
15704 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15705 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15706 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15707 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15710 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15711 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15715 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15716 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15720 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15724 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15725 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15726 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15727 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15728 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15729 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15730 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15734 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15737 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15738 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15739 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15740 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15741 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15742 additional columns.
15745 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15746 the table. The default value is nil.
15750 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15751 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15752 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15753 number of different solutions:
15757 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15758 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15759 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15761 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15762 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15765 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15766 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15767 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15768 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15772 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15773 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15774 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15776 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15777 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15778 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15779 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15780 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15781 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15782 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15783 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15784 will then get the following template:
15786 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15788 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15789 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15791 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15797 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15798 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15799 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15800 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15801 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15802 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15803 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15804 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15805 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15806 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15807 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15808 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15811 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15812 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15814 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15815 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15816 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15817 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15818 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15819 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15820 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15821 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15826 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15827 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15829 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15830 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
15831 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15832 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e.@: to not produce
15833 header and footer commands of the target table:
15836 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15837 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15838 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15839 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15843 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15844 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15845 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15846 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15847 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15848 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15849 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15853 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15854 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15855 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15856 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15859 @item :splice nil/t
15860 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15861 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15864 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15865 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15866 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15867 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15868 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15869 function must return a formatted string.
15872 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15873 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15874 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15875 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15876 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15877 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15878 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15879 supplied instead of strings.
15882 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15883 @subsection Translator functions
15884 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15885 @cindex translator function
15887 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15888 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15889 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15890 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15891 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15892 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15893 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15894 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15895 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15899 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15900 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15901 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15902 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15905 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15906 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15907 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15908 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15909 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15913 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15914 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15915 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e.@: the
15916 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15917 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15918 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15919 overrule the default with
15922 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15925 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15926 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15927 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15928 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15929 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15930 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15934 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15935 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15939 Please check the documentation string of the function
15940 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15941 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15942 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15943 using the generic function.
15945 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15946 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15947 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15948 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15949 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15950 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15951 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15952 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15953 others can benefit from your work.
15955 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15956 @subsection Radio lists
15957 @cindex radio lists
15958 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15960 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15961 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15962 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15963 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15965 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15969 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15971 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15973 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15976 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15979 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15984 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15985 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15987 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15996 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
15997 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
15999 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16000 @section Dynamic blocks
16001 @cindex dynamic blocks
16003 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16004 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16005 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16006 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16008 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16009 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16010 the content of the block.
16012 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16014 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16019 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16022 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16023 Update dynamic block at point.
16024 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16025 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16028 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16029 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16030 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16031 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16032 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16034 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16035 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16036 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16037 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16041 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16047 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16050 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16051 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16052 (insert "Last block update at: "
16053 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16056 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16057 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16058 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16059 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16062 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16063 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16065 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16066 @section Special agenda views
16067 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16069 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16070 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16071 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16072 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16073 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16074 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16075 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16076 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16077 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16078 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16079 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16081 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16082 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16083 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16084 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16085 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16086 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16088 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16089 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16090 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16091 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16092 search should continue from there.
16095 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16096 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16097 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16098 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16099 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16100 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16103 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16107 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16108 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16109 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16110 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16113 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16114 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16115 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16117 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16118 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16119 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16120 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16121 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16122 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16123 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16124 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16125 you really want to have.
16127 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16128 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16129 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16132 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16133 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16134 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16135 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16136 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16137 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16138 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16139 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16140 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16141 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16142 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16143 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16144 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16145 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16146 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16147 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16148 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16149 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16150 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16151 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16152 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16155 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16156 like this, even without defining a special function:
16159 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16160 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16161 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16162 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16163 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16166 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16167 @section Extracting agenda information
16168 @cindex agenda, pipe
16169 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16171 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16172 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16173 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16174 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16175 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16176 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16177 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16178 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16179 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16180 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16181 current TODO list, you could use
16184 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16187 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16188 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16189 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16190 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16193 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16194 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16198 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16201 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16202 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16203 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16204 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16205 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16210 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16211 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16213 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16214 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16215 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16216 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16220 category @r{The category of the item}
16221 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16222 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16223 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16224 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16225 diary @r{imported from diary}
16226 deadline @r{a deadline}
16227 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16228 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16229 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16230 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16231 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16232 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16233 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16234 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16235 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16236 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16237 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16238 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16239 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16243 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16244 led to the selection of the item.
16246 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16247 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16248 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16253 # define the Emacs command to run
16254 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16256 # run it and capture the output
16257 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16259 # loop over all lines
16260 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16261 # get the individual values
16262 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16263 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16264 # process and print
16265 print "[ ] $head\n";
16269 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16270 @section Using the property API
16271 @cindex API, for properties
16272 @cindex properties, API
16274 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16277 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16278 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16279 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16280 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16281 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16282 if the property key was used several times.@*
16283 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16284 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16285 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16287 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16288 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16289 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16290 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
16291 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16292 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16293 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16294 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16295 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16298 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16299 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16302 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16303 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16306 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16307 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16310 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16311 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16314 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16315 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
16316 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16319 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16320 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16321 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16324 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16325 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16326 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16329 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16330 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16331 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16334 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16335 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16336 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16339 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16340 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16341 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16342 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16343 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16344 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16345 responsible for this property.
16348 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16349 @section Using the mapping API
16350 @cindex API, for mapping
16351 @cindex mapping entries, API
16353 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16354 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16355 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16356 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16359 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16360 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16362 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16363 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16364 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16365 returned as a list.
16367 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16368 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16369 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16370 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16371 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16372 if you have removed (e.g.@: archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16373 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16374 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16375 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16378 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16379 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16380 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16381 visited by the iteration.
16383 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16386 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16387 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16388 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16389 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16391 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16392 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16393 agenda-with-archives
16394 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16396 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16399 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16400 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16402 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16404 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16405 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16406 function or Lisp form
16407 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16408 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16409 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16410 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16414 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16415 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16416 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16417 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16419 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16420 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16421 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16424 @defun org-priority &optional action
16425 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16426 possible values for ACTION.
16429 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16430 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16431 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16435 Promote the current entry.
16439 Demote the current entry.
16442 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16443 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16444 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16448 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16449 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16452 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16453 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16456 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16459 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16460 @appendix MobileOrg
16464 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16465 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16466 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16467 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16468 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16469 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16470 Moreland. Android users should check out
16471 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16472 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16475 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16476 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16477 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16479 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16480 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16481 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16482 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16483 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16484 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16485 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16488 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16489 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16490 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16493 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16494 @section Setting up the staging area
16496 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16497 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16498 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16499 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16500 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16501 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16502 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16503 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16504 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16505 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16506 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16508 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16509 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16510 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16511 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16512 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16513 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16514 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16518 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16521 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16522 and to read captured notes from there.
16524 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16525 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16527 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16528 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16529 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16530 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16531 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16532 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16533 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16534 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16535 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16536 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16537 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16538 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16539 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16540 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16541 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16542 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16543 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16544 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16546 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16547 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16549 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16550 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16551 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16552 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16553 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16557 Org moves all entries found in
16558 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16559 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16560 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16561 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16563 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16564 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16565 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16566 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16567 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16568 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16569 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16570 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16572 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16573 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16574 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16575 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16580 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16581 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16582 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16583 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16584 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16585 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16586 this flagged entry is finished.
16591 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16592 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16593 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16594 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16595 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16596 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16597 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16599 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
16600 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16601 @cindex acknowledgments
16605 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16606 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16607 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16608 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16609 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16610 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16611 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16612 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16613 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16614 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16615 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16616 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16617 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16618 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16619 functionality directly into a notes file.
16621 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16622 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16623 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16624 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16625 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16626 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16627 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16630 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16633 @item Bastien Guerry
16634 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16635 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16636 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16637 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16638 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16639 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16640 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16641 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16642 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16643 programming and reproducible research.
16645 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16646 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16647 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16648 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16649 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16650 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16651 @item Sebastian Rose
16652 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16653 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16654 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16655 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16656 single-key navigation.
16659 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
16660 know what I am missing here!
16665 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16667 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16669 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16672 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16674 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16676 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16678 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16680 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16681 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16683 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16686 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16687 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16688 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16690 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16692 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16694 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16695 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16698 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16700 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16701 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16702 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16704 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16705 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16707 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16708 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16709 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16711 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16714 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16716 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16718 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16719 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16721 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16723 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16725 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16727 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16730 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16731 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16733 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16735 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16737 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16739 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16742 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16743 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16744 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16746 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16749 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16751 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16752 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16754 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16756 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16758 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16759 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16761 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16762 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16764 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16765 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16766 small fixes and patches.
16768 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16770 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16772 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16775 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16778 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16780 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16781 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16783 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16785 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16787 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16788 file links, and TAGS.
16790 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16791 version of the reference card.
16793 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16796 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16798 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16799 links, among other things.
16801 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16802 provided frequent feedback.
16804 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16805 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16807 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16809 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16812 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16813 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16815 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16817 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16818 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16820 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16823 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16824 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16826 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16829 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16831 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16832 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16834 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16835 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16837 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16838 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16840 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16843 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16845 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16846 tweaks and features.
16848 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16849 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16851 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16852 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16854 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16855 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16857 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16858 chapter about publishing.
16860 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16862 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16863 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16865 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16866 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16867 concept index for HTML export.
16869 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16872 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16874 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16877 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16880 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16883 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16886 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16887 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16891 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16892 @unnumbered Concept index
16896 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16897 @unnumbered Key index
16901 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16902 @unnumbered Command and function index
16906 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16907 @unnumbered Variable index
16909 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16910 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16911 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16917 @c Local variables:
16919 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16920 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16921 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16925 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre